1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GDB.
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21 #include "arch-utils.h"
26 #include "breakpoint.h"
27 #include "tracepoint.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
36 #include "gdbthread.h"
39 #include "gdb-demangle.h"
40 #include "filenames.h"
46 #include "completer.h"
48 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
52 #include "observable.h"
58 #include "parser-defs.h"
59 #include "gdb_regex.h"
61 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
64 #include "dummy-frame.h"
66 #include "gdbsupport/format.h"
67 #include "thread-fsm.h"
68 #include "tid-parse.h"
69 #include "cli/cli-style.h"
71 /* readline include files */
72 #include "readline/tilde.h"
74 /* readline defines this. */
77 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
78 #include "extension.h"
80 #include "progspace-and-thread.h"
81 #include "gdbsupport/array-view.h"
82 #include "gdbsupport/gdb_optional.h"
84 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
86 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *,
87 gdb::function_view
<void (breakpoint
*)>);
89 static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint
*);
92 create_sals_from_location_default (struct event_location
*location
,
93 struct linespec_result
*canonical
,
94 enum bptype type_wanted
);
96 static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch
*,
97 struct linespec_result
*,
98 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char>,
99 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char>,
101 enum bpdisp
, int, int,
103 const struct breakpoint_ops
*,
104 int, int, int, unsigned);
106 static std::vector
<symtab_and_line
> decode_location_default
107 (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct event_location
*location
,
108 struct program_space
*search_pspace
);
110 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint
111 (const std::vector
<value_ref_ptr
> &vals
);
113 static void mention (struct breakpoint
*);
115 static struct breakpoint
*set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch
*,
117 const struct breakpoint_ops
*);
118 static struct bp_location
*add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint
*,
119 const struct symtab_and_line
*);
121 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
123 struct breakpoint
*set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
124 struct symtab_and_line
,
126 const struct breakpoint_ops
*);
128 static struct breakpoint
*
129 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint
*orig
,
131 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
,
134 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR
, CORE_ADDR
, int, int);
136 static CORE_ADDR
adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
140 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch
*,
141 struct program_space
*, CORE_ADDR
,
142 struct obj_section
*, int);
144 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location
*loc1
,
145 struct bp_location
*loc2
);
147 static int breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location
*loc1
,
148 struct bp_location
*loc2
,
149 bool sw_hw_bps_match
= false);
151 static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location
*bl
,
152 const struct address_space
*aspace
,
155 static int breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location
*,
156 const address_space
*,
159 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location
*);
160 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location
*, enum remove_bp_reason
);
162 static enum print_stop_action
print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs
);
164 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
166 static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint
*);
168 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint
*except
,
170 int *other_type_used
);
172 static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint
*, enum bpdisp
,
175 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location
*loc
);
176 static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location
*loc
);
177 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location
**loc
);
179 static struct bp_location
*allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint
*bpt
);
181 /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to
182 insert locations now. */
183 enum ugll_insert_mode
185 /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only
186 remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be
187 inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints
188 should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't
189 have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
190 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
191 returns true on them.
193 This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
194 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but
195 breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT*
196 be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the
197 target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from
198 GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from
202 /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now
203 claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */
206 /* Insert locations now, irrespective of
207 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are
208 stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to
209 insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but
210 UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because
211 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point,
212 as no thread is running yet. */
216 static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode
);
218 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode
);
220 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
222 static void trace_pass_command (const char *, int);
224 static void set_tracepoint_count (int num
);
226 static bool is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint
*b
);
228 static struct bp_location
**get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address
);
230 /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
233 static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint
*b
);
235 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
236 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
237 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
238 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops
;
240 /* Internal breakpoints class type. */
241 static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops
;
243 /* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
244 static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops
;
246 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
248 struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops
;
250 /* Breakpoints set on probes. */
251 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops
;
253 /* Tracepoints set on probes. */
254 static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops
;
256 /* Dynamic printf class type. */
257 struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops
;
259 /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
260 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
261 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
262 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
263 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
264 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
266 static const char dprintf_style_gdb
[] = "gdb";
267 static const char dprintf_style_call
[] = "call";
268 static const char dprintf_style_agent
[] = "agent";
269 static const char *const dprintf_style_enums
[] = {
275 static const char *dprintf_style
= dprintf_style_gdb
;
277 /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
278 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
279 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
280 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
282 static char *dprintf_function
;
284 /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
285 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
286 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
287 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
288 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
289 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
290 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
292 static char *dprintf_channel
;
294 /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
296 static bool disconnected_dprintf
= true;
298 struct command_line
*
299 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint
*b
)
301 return b
->commands
? b
->commands
.get () : NULL
;
304 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
305 current breakpoint. */
307 static bool breakpoint_proceeded
;
310 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp
)
312 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
313 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
315 static const char * const bpdisps
[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
317 return bpdisps
[(int) disp
];
320 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
321 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
322 if such is available. */
323 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints
;
326 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file
*file
, int from_tty
,
327 struct cmd_list_element
*c
,
330 fprintf_filtered (file
,
331 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
332 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
336 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
337 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
338 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
339 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
340 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support
;
342 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file
*file
, int from_tty
,
343 struct cmd_list_element
*c
,
346 fprintf_filtered (file
,
347 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
348 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
352 /* If true, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
353 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
354 If false, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
355 use hardware breakpoints. */
356 static bool automatic_hardware_breakpoints
;
358 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file
*file
, int from_tty
,
359 struct cmd_list_element
*c
,
362 fprintf_filtered (file
,
363 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
367 /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is
368 stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as
369 they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of
370 the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting
371 breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the
372 target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while
373 processing user input. */
374 static bool always_inserted_mode
= false;
377 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file
*file
, int from_tty
,
378 struct cmd_list_element
*c
, const char *value
)
380 fprintf_filtered (file
, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
384 /* See breakpoint.h. */
387 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void)
389 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
391 /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no
392 thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are
393 no threads under GDB's control yet. */
398 if (always_inserted_mode
)
400 /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads
405 for (inferior
*inf
: all_inferiors ())
406 if (inf
->has_execution ()
407 && threads_are_executing (inf
->process_target ()))
410 /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are
411 stopped, we still have events to process. */
412 for (thread_info
*tp
: all_non_exited_threads ())
414 && tp
->suspend
.waitstatus_pending_p
)
420 static const char condition_evaluation_both
[] = "host or target";
422 /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
423 static const char condition_evaluation_auto
[] = "auto";
424 static const char condition_evaluation_host
[] = "host";
425 static const char condition_evaluation_target
[] = "target";
426 static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums
[] = {
427 condition_evaluation_auto
,
428 condition_evaluation_host
,
429 condition_evaluation_target
,
433 /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
434 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1
= condition_evaluation_auto
;
436 /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
437 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
438 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode
= condition_evaluation_auto
;
440 /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
441 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
442 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
446 translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode
)
448 if (mode
== condition_evaluation_auto
)
450 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
451 return condition_evaluation_target
;
453 return condition_evaluation_host
;
459 /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
462 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
464 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode
);
467 /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
471 gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
473 const char *mode
= breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
475 return (mode
== condition_evaluation_host
);
478 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
479 static int executing_breakpoint_commands
;
481 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
482 static int overlay_events_enabled
;
484 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
485 bool target_exact_watchpoints
= false;
487 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
488 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
489 current breakpoint. */
491 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
493 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
494 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
495 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
498 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
499 not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
500 while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
502 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
503 for (BP_TMP = bp_locations; \
504 BP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count && (B = *BP_TMP);\
507 /* Iterates through locations with address ADDRESS for the currently selected
508 program space. BP_LOCP_TMP points to each object. BP_LOCP_START points
509 to where the loop should start from.
510 If BP_LOCP_START is a NULL pointer, the macro automatically seeks the
511 appropriate location to start with. */
513 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR(BP_LOCP_TMP, BP_LOCP_START, ADDRESS) \
514 for (BP_LOCP_START = BP_LOCP_START == NULL ? get_first_locp_gte_addr (ADDRESS) : BP_LOCP_START, \
515 BP_LOCP_TMP = BP_LOCP_START; \
517 && (BP_LOCP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count \
518 && (*BP_LOCP_TMP)->address == ADDRESS); \
521 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
523 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
524 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
525 if (is_tracepoint (B))
527 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
529 static struct breakpoint
*breakpoint_chain
;
531 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_is_less_than - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
533 static struct bp_location
**bp_locations
;
535 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATIONS. */
537 static unsigned bp_locations_count
;
539 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
540 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid
541 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
542 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to scan for shadow bytes for
543 an address you need to read. */
545 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
;
547 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
548 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
549 BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
550 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to
551 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
553 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
;
555 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
556 from the bp_locations array, but for which a hit may still be
557 reported by a target. */
558 static std::vector
<bp_location
*> moribund_locations
;
560 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
562 static int breakpoint_count
;
564 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
565 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
566 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
567 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
568 static int prev_breakpoint_count
;
570 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
572 static int tracepoint_count
;
574 static struct cmd_list_element
*breakpoint_set_cmdlist
;
575 static struct cmd_list_element
*breakpoint_show_cmdlist
;
576 struct cmd_list_element
*save_cmdlist
;
578 /* See declaration at breakpoint.h. */
581 breakpoint_find_if (int (*func
) (struct breakpoint
*b
, void *d
),
584 struct breakpoint
*b
= NULL
;
588 if (func (b
, user_data
) != 0)
595 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
597 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint
*b
)
599 return (b
->enable_state
== bp_enabled
);
602 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
605 set_breakpoint_count (int num
)
607 prev_breakpoint_count
= breakpoint_count
;
608 breakpoint_count
= num
;
609 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num
);
612 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
613 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
614 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count
;
616 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
619 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
621 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count
= breakpoint_count
;
624 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
627 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::~scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
629 prev_breakpoint_count
= rbreak_start_breakpoint_count
;
632 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
635 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
637 struct breakpoint
*b
;
644 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
645 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
648 get_breakpoint (int num
)
650 struct breakpoint
*b
;
653 if (b
->number
== num
)
661 /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
662 evaluating conditions on its side. */
665 mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint
*b
)
667 struct bp_location
*loc
;
669 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
670 evaluating conditions and if the user has
671 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
673 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
674 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
677 if (!is_breakpoint (b
))
680 for (loc
= b
->loc
; loc
; loc
= loc
->next
)
681 loc
->condition_changed
= condition_modified
;
684 /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
685 evaluating conditions on its side. */
688 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location
*loc
)
690 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
691 evaluating conditions and if the user has
692 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
694 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
695 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
699 if (!is_breakpoint (loc
->owner
))
702 loc
->condition_changed
= condition_modified
;
705 /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
706 condition_evaluation_mode. */
709 set_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *args
, int from_tty
,
710 struct cmd_list_element
*c
)
712 const char *old_mode
, *new_mode
;
714 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1
== condition_evaluation_target
)
715 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
717 condition_evaluation_mode_1
= condition_evaluation_mode
;
718 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
719 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
723 new_mode
= translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1
);
724 old_mode
= translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode
);
726 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
727 settings was "auto". */
728 condition_evaluation_mode
= condition_evaluation_mode_1
;
730 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
731 if (new_mode
!= old_mode
)
733 struct bp_location
*loc
, **loc_tmp
;
734 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
735 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
737 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
738 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
741 if (new_mode
== condition_evaluation_target
)
743 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
745 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc
, loc_tmp
)
746 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc
);
750 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
751 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
752 target knows about. */
753 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc
, loc_tmp
)
754 if (is_breakpoint (loc
->owner
) && loc
->inserted
)
755 loc
->needs_update
= 1;
759 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT
);
765 /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
766 what "auto" is translating to. */
769 show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file
*file
, int from_tty
,
770 struct cmd_list_element
*c
, const char *value
)
772 if (condition_evaluation_mode
== condition_evaluation_auto
)
773 fprintf_filtered (file
,
774 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
775 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
777 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
779 fprintf_filtered (file
, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
783 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP that is used by
784 bsearch. This comparison function only cares about addresses, unlike
785 the more general bp_location_is_less_than function. */
788 bp_locations_compare_addrs (const void *ap
, const void *bp
)
790 const struct bp_location
*a
= *(const struct bp_location
**) ap
;
791 const struct bp_location
*b
= *(const struct bp_location
**) bp
;
793 if (a
->address
== b
->address
)
796 return ((a
->address
> b
->address
) - (a
->address
< b
->address
));
799 /* Helper function to skip all bp_locations with addresses
800 less than ADDRESS. It returns the first bp_location that
801 is greater than or equal to ADDRESS. If none is found, just
804 static struct bp_location
**
805 get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address
)
807 struct bp_location dummy_loc
;
808 struct bp_location
*dummy_locp
= &dummy_loc
;
809 struct bp_location
**locp_found
= NULL
;
811 /* Initialize the dummy location's address field. */
812 dummy_loc
.address
= address
;
814 /* Find a close match to the first location at ADDRESS. */
815 locp_found
= ((struct bp_location
**)
816 bsearch (&dummy_locp
, bp_locations
, bp_locations_count
,
817 sizeof (struct bp_location
**),
818 bp_locations_compare_addrs
));
820 /* Nothing was found, nothing left to do. */
821 if (locp_found
== NULL
)
824 /* We may have found a location that is at ADDRESS but is not the first in the
825 location's list. Go backwards (if possible) and locate the first one. */
826 while ((locp_found
- 1) >= bp_locations
827 && (*(locp_found
- 1))->address
== address
)
834 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint
*b
, const char *exp
,
839 xfree (b
->cond_string
);
840 b
->cond_string
= nullptr;
842 if (is_watchpoint (b
))
843 static_cast<watchpoint
*> (b
)->cond_exp
.reset ();
846 for (bp_location
*loc
= b
->loc
; loc
!= nullptr; loc
= loc
->next
)
850 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
851 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
852 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
857 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b
->number
);
861 if (is_watchpoint (b
))
863 innermost_block_tracker tracker
;
864 const char *arg
= exp
;
865 expression_up new_exp
= parse_exp_1 (&arg
, 0, 0, 0, &tracker
);
867 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
868 watchpoint
*w
= static_cast<watchpoint
*> (b
);
869 w
->cond_exp
= std::move (new_exp
);
870 w
->cond_exp_valid_block
= tracker
.block ();
874 /* Parse and set condition expressions. We make two passes.
875 In the first, we parse the condition string to see if it
876 is valid in all locations. If so, the condition would be
877 accepted. So we go ahead and set the locations'
878 conditions. In case a failing case is found, we throw
879 the error and the condition string will be rejected.
880 This two-pass approach is taken to avoid setting the
881 state of locations in case of a reject. */
882 for (bp_location
*loc
= b
->loc
; loc
!= nullptr; loc
= loc
->next
)
884 const char *arg
= exp
;
885 parse_exp_1 (&arg
, loc
->address
,
886 block_for_pc (loc
->address
), 0);
888 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
891 /* If we reach here, the condition is valid at all locations. */
892 for (bp_location
*loc
= b
->loc
; loc
!= nullptr; loc
= loc
->next
)
894 const char *arg
= exp
;
896 parse_exp_1 (&arg
, loc
->address
,
897 block_for_pc (loc
->address
), 0);
901 /* We know that the new condition parsed successfully. The
902 condition string of the breakpoint can be safely updated. */
903 xfree (b
->cond_string
);
904 b
->cond_string
= xstrdup (exp
);
905 b
->condition_not_parsed
= 0;
907 mark_breakpoint_modified (b
);
909 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified
.notify (b
);
912 /* Completion for the "condition" command. */
915 condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element
*cmd
,
916 completion_tracker
&tracker
,
917 const char *text
, const char *word
)
921 text
= skip_spaces (text
);
922 space
= skip_to_space (text
);
926 struct breakpoint
*b
;
930 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
931 if (!isdigit (text
[1]))
932 complete_internalvar (tracker
, &text
[1]);
936 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
943 xsnprintf (number
, sizeof (number
), "%d", b
->number
);
945 if (strncmp (number
, text
, len
) == 0)
946 tracker
.add_completion (make_unique_xstrdup (number
));
952 /* We're completing the expression part. */
953 text
= skip_spaces (space
);
954 expression_completer (cmd
, tracker
, text
, word
);
957 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
960 condition_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
962 struct breakpoint
*b
;
967 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
970 bnum
= get_number (&p
);
972 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg
);
975 if (b
->number
== bnum
)
977 /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
978 extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
979 from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
980 const struct extension_language_defn
*extlang
981 = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b
, EXT_LANG_NONE
);
985 error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
986 " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
987 ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang
));
989 set_breakpoint_condition (b
, p
, from_tty
);
991 if (is_breakpoint (b
))
992 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT
);
997 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum
);
1000 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
1001 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
1002 Throw if any such commands is found. */
1005 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line
*commands
)
1007 struct command_line
*c
;
1009 for (c
= commands
; c
; c
= c
->next
)
1011 if (c
->control_type
== while_stepping_control
)
1012 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1013 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1015 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c
->body_list_0
.get ());
1016 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c
->body_list_1
.get ());
1018 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1019 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1020 command directly. */
1021 if (strstr (c
->line
, "collect ") == c
->line
)
1022 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1024 if (strstr (c
->line
, "teval ") == c
->line
)
1025 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1029 struct longjmp_breakpoint
: public breakpoint
1031 ~longjmp_breakpoint () override
;
1034 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1037 is_tracepoint_type (bptype type
)
1039 return (type
== bp_tracepoint
1040 || type
== bp_fast_tracepoint
1041 || type
== bp_static_tracepoint
);
1045 is_longjmp_type (bptype type
)
1047 return type
== bp_longjmp
|| type
== bp_exception
;
1050 /* See breakpoint.h. */
1053 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint
*b
)
1055 return is_tracepoint_type (b
->type
);
1058 /* Factory function to create an appropriate instance of breakpoint given
1061 static std::unique_ptr
<breakpoint
>
1062 new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype type
)
1066 if (is_tracepoint_type (type
))
1067 b
= new tracepoint ();
1068 else if (is_longjmp_type (type
))
1069 b
= new longjmp_breakpoint ();
1071 b
= new breakpoint ();
1073 return std::unique_ptr
<breakpoint
> (b
);
1076 /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1077 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1081 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint
*b
,
1082 struct command_line
*commands
)
1084 if (is_tracepoint (b
))
1086 struct tracepoint
*t
= (struct tracepoint
*) b
;
1087 struct command_line
*c
;
1088 struct command_line
*while_stepping
= 0;
1090 /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
1091 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
1095 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1096 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1097 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
1098 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
1099 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
1100 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
1101 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
1102 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
1103 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
1104 tracepoint's context. */
1105 for (c
= commands
; c
; c
= c
->next
)
1107 if (c
->control_type
== while_stepping_control
)
1109 if (b
->type
== bp_fast_tracepoint
)
1110 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1111 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1112 else if (b
->type
== bp_static_tracepoint
)
1113 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1114 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1117 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1118 "can be used only once"));
1123 validate_actionline (c
->line
, b
);
1127 struct command_line
*c2
;
1129 gdb_assert (while_stepping
->body_list_1
== nullptr);
1130 c2
= while_stepping
->body_list_0
.get ();
1131 for (; c2
; c2
= c2
->next
)
1133 if (c2
->control_type
== while_stepping_control
)
1134 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1140 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands
);
1144 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1145 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1147 std::vector
<breakpoint
*>
1148 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr
)
1150 struct breakpoint
*b
;
1151 std::vector
<breakpoint
*> found
;
1152 struct bp_location
*loc
;
1155 if (b
->type
== bp_static_tracepoint
)
1157 for (loc
= b
->loc
; loc
; loc
= loc
->next
)
1158 if (loc
->address
== addr
)
1159 found
.push_back (b
);
1165 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1166 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1169 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint
*b
,
1170 counted_command_line
&&commands
)
1172 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b
, commands
.get ());
1174 b
->commands
= std::move (commands
);
1175 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified
.notify (b
);
1178 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1179 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1183 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint
*b
, int silent
)
1185 int old_silent
= b
->silent
;
1188 if (old_silent
!= silent
)
1189 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified
.notify (b
);
1192 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1193 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1196 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint
*b
, int thread
)
1198 int old_thread
= b
->thread
;
1201 if (old_thread
!= thread
)
1202 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified
.notify (b
);
1205 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1206 breakpoint work for any task. */
1209 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint
*b
, int task
)
1211 int old_task
= b
->task
;
1214 if (old_task
!= task
)
1215 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified
.notify (b
);
1219 commands_command_1 (const char *arg
, int from_tty
,
1220 struct command_line
*control
)
1222 counted_command_line cmd
;
1223 /* cmd_read will be true once we have read cmd. Note that cmd might still be
1224 NULL after the call to read_command_lines if the user provides an empty
1225 list of command by just typing "end". */
1226 bool cmd_read
= false;
1228 std::string new_arg
;
1230 if (arg
== NULL
|| !*arg
)
1232 if (breakpoint_count
- prev_breakpoint_count
> 1)
1233 new_arg
= string_printf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count
+ 1,
1235 else if (breakpoint_count
> 0)
1236 new_arg
= string_printf ("%d", breakpoint_count
);
1237 arg
= new_arg
.c_str ();
1240 map_breakpoint_numbers
1241 (arg
, [&] (breakpoint
*b
)
1245 gdb_assert (cmd
== NULL
);
1246 if (control
!= NULL
)
1247 cmd
= control
->body_list_0
;
1251 = string_printf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1252 "%s, one per line."),
1255 auto do_validate
= [=] (const char *line
)
1257 validate_actionline (line
, b
);
1259 gdb::function_view
<void (const char *)> validator
;
1260 if (is_tracepoint (b
))
1261 validator
= do_validate
;
1263 cmd
= read_command_lines (str
.c_str (), from_tty
, 1, validator
);
1268 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1270 if (b
->commands
!= cmd
)
1272 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b
, cmd
.get ());
1274 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified
.notify (b
);
1280 commands_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
1282 commands_command_1 (arg
, from_tty
, NULL
);
1285 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1286 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1288 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1289 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1290 enum command_control_type
1291 commands_from_control_command (const char *arg
, struct command_line
*cmd
)
1293 commands_command_1 (arg
, 0, cmd
);
1294 return simple_control
;
1297 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1300 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location
*bl
)
1302 if (bl
->loc_type
!= bp_loc_software_breakpoint
)
1306 if (bl
->target_info
.shadow_len
== 0)
1307 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1312 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
1313 MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
1316 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
1317 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
1318 failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
1321 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte
*readbuf
, gdb_byte
*writebuf
,
1322 const gdb_byte
*writebuf_org
,
1323 ULONGEST memaddr
, LONGEST len
,
1324 struct bp_target_info
*target_info
,
1325 struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
)
1327 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1328 CORE_ADDR bp_addr
= 0;
1332 if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info
->placed_address_space
, 0,
1333 current_program_space
->aspace
, 0))
1335 /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
1339 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1341 bp_addr
= target_info
->placed_address
;
1342 bp_size
= target_info
->shadow_len
;
1344 if (bp_addr
+ bp_size
<= memaddr
)
1346 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
1351 if (bp_addr
>= memaddr
+ len
)
1353 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1358 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1359 if (bp_addr
< memaddr
)
1361 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1362 bp_size
-= memaddr
- bp_addr
;
1363 bptoffset
= memaddr
- bp_addr
;
1367 if (bp_addr
+ bp_size
> memaddr
+ len
)
1369 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1370 bp_size
-= (bp_addr
+ bp_size
) - (memaddr
+ len
);
1373 if (readbuf
!= NULL
)
1375 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
1376 shadow_contents buffer. */
1377 gdb_assert (target_info
->shadow_contents
>= readbuf
+ len
1378 || readbuf
>= (target_info
->shadow_contents
1379 + target_info
->shadow_len
));
1381 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1383 memcpy (readbuf
+ bp_addr
- memaddr
,
1384 target_info
->shadow_contents
+ bptoffset
, bp_size
);
1388 const unsigned char *bp
;
1389 CORE_ADDR addr
= target_info
->reqstd_address
;
1392 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1393 memcpy (target_info
->shadow_contents
+ bptoffset
,
1394 writebuf_org
+ bp_addr
- memaddr
, bp_size
);
1396 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1398 bp
= gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch
, &addr
, &placed_size
);
1400 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1401 breakpoint's INSN. */
1402 memcpy (writebuf
+ bp_addr
- memaddr
, bp
+ bptoffset
, bp_size
);
1406 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1407 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1409 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1410 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1411 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1413 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1414 bl->address - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1415 up to bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1416 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1417 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1418 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1419 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1420 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
1422 bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1425 breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte
*readbuf
, gdb_byte
*writebuf
,
1426 const gdb_byte
*writebuf_org
,
1427 ULONGEST memaddr
, LONGEST len
)
1429 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1431 unsigned bc_l
, bc_r
, bc
;
1433 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1434 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1435 report higher one. */
1438 bc_r
= bp_locations_count
;
1439 while (bc_l
+ 1 < bc_r
)
1441 struct bp_location
*bl
;
1443 bc
= (bc_l
+ bc_r
) / 2;
1444 bl
= bp_locations
[bc
];
1446 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1447 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1448 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1449 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1451 Use the BP_LOCATIONS_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1452 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1453 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1455 if ((bl
->address
+ bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1457 && (bl
->address
+ bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1464 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1465 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1466 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1467 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1468 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1471 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1473 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1474 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1475 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1478 && bp_locations
[bc_l
]->address
== bp_locations
[bc_l
- 1]->address
)
1481 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1483 for (bc
= bc_l
; bc
< bp_locations_count
; bc
++)
1485 struct bp_location
*bl
= bp_locations
[bc
];
1487 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1488 if (bl
->owner
->type
== bp_none
)
1489 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1492 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1495 if (bl
->address
>= bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1496 && memaddr
+ len
<= (bl
->address
1497 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
))
1500 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl
))
1503 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf
, writebuf
, writebuf_org
,
1504 memaddr
, len
, &bl
->target_info
, bl
->gdbarch
);
1508 /* See breakpoint.h. */
1511 is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint
*bpt
)
1513 return (bpt
->type
== bp_breakpoint
1514 || bpt
->type
== bp_hardware_breakpoint
1515 || bpt
->type
== bp_dprintf
);
1518 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1521 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint
*bpt
)
1523 return (bpt
->type
== bp_hardware_watchpoint
1524 || bpt
->type
== bp_read_watchpoint
1525 || bpt
->type
== bp_access_watchpoint
);
1528 /* See breakpoint.h. */
1531 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint
*bpt
)
1533 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt
)
1534 || bpt
->type
== bp_watchpoint
);
1537 /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1538 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1539 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1540 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1541 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1542 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1543 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1544 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1547 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint
*b
)
1549 return (b
->pspace
== current_program_space
1550 && (b
->watchpoint_thread
== null_ptid
1551 || (inferior_ptid
== b
->watchpoint_thread
1552 && !inferior_thread ()->executing
)));
1555 /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1556 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1559 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint
*w
)
1561 if (w
->related_breakpoint
!= w
)
1563 gdb_assert (w
->related_breakpoint
->type
== bp_watchpoint_scope
);
1564 gdb_assert (w
->related_breakpoint
->related_breakpoint
== w
);
1565 w
->related_breakpoint
->disposition
= disp_del_at_next_stop
;
1566 w
->related_breakpoint
->related_breakpoint
= w
->related_breakpoint
;
1567 w
->related_breakpoint
= w
;
1569 w
->disposition
= disp_del_at_next_stop
;
1572 /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in
1575 static struct value
*
1576 extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint
*w
, struct value
*val
)
1578 struct value
*bit_val
;
1583 bit_val
= allocate_value (value_type (val
));
1585 unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val
,
1588 value_contents_for_printing (val
),
1595 /* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B, which must be a software
1596 watchpoint. This is required because even if a software watchpoint
1597 is not watching any memory, bpstat_stop_status requires a location
1598 to be able to report stops. */
1601 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (struct breakpoint
*b
,
1602 struct program_space
*pspace
)
1604 gdb_assert (b
->type
== bp_watchpoint
&& b
->loc
== NULL
);
1606 b
->loc
= allocate_bp_location (b
);
1607 b
->loc
->pspace
= pspace
;
1608 b
->loc
->address
= -1;
1609 b
->loc
->length
= -1;
1612 /* Returns true if B is a software watchpoint that is not watching any
1613 memory (e.g., "watch $pc"). */
1616 is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (struct breakpoint
*b
)
1618 return (b
->type
== bp_watchpoint
1620 && b
->loc
->next
== NULL
1621 && b
->loc
->address
== -1
1622 && b
->loc
->length
== -1);
1625 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1626 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1627 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1628 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1630 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1632 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1633 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1636 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1637 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1638 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1639 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1640 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1641 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1642 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1643 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1645 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1646 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1647 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1648 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1649 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1650 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1651 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1652 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1655 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1656 hardware watchpoints:
1658 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1659 called several times when GDB stops.
1662 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1663 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1664 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1665 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1666 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1667 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1668 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1669 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1670 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1671 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1672 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1674 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1675 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1678 update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint
*b
, int reparse
)
1680 int within_current_scope
;
1681 struct frame_id saved_frame_id
;
1684 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1685 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1686 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1687 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b
))
1690 if (b
->disposition
== disp_del_at_next_stop
)
1695 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1696 if (b
->exp_valid_block
== NULL
)
1697 within_current_scope
= 1;
1700 struct frame_info
*fi
= get_current_frame ();
1701 struct gdbarch
*frame_arch
= get_frame_arch (fi
);
1702 CORE_ADDR frame_pc
= get_frame_pc (fi
);
1704 /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed
1705 (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work
1706 properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1707 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1708 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch
, frame_pc
))
1711 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1712 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1713 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1714 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1717 saved_frame_id
= get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL
));
1719 fi
= frame_find_by_id (b
->watchpoint_frame
);
1720 within_current_scope
= (fi
!= NULL
);
1721 if (within_current_scope
)
1725 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1726 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1727 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1730 if (within_current_scope
&& reparse
)
1735 s
= b
->exp_string_reparse
? b
->exp_string_reparse
: b
->exp_string
;
1736 b
->exp
= parse_exp_1 (&s
, 0, b
->exp_valid_block
, 0);
1737 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1738 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1739 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1740 be completely different objects. */
1742 b
->val_valid
= false;
1744 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1745 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1746 locations (re)created below. */
1747 if (b
->cond_string
!= NULL
)
1749 b
->cond_exp
.reset ();
1752 b
->cond_exp
= parse_exp_1 (&s
, 0, b
->cond_exp_valid_block
, 0);
1756 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1757 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1758 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1759 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1760 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1761 if (!target_has_execution
)
1763 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1764 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1765 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1766 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints
)
1768 if (b
->ops
->works_in_software_mode (b
))
1769 b
->type
= bp_watchpoint
;
1771 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1772 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1775 else if (within_current_scope
&& b
->exp
)
1778 std::vector
<value_ref_ptr
> val_chain
;
1779 struct value
*v
, *result
;
1780 struct program_space
*frame_pspace
;
1782 fetch_subexp_value (b
->exp
.get (), &pc
, &v
, &result
, &val_chain
, 0);
1784 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1785 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1786 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1787 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1788 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1790 if (!b
->val_valid
&& !is_masked_watchpoint (b
))
1792 if (b
->val_bitsize
!= 0)
1793 v
= extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b
, v
);
1794 b
->val
= release_value (v
);
1795 b
->val_valid
= true;
1798 frame_pspace
= get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL
));
1800 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1801 gdb_assert (!val_chain
.empty ());
1802 for (const value_ref_ptr
&iter
: val_chain
)
1806 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1807 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1808 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1809 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1810 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1811 if (VALUE_LVAL (v
) == lval_memory
1812 && (v
== val_chain
[0] || ! value_lazy (v
)))
1814 struct type
*vtype
= check_typedef (value_type (v
));
1816 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1817 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1818 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1820 || (vtype
->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1821 && vtype
->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
))
1824 enum target_hw_bp_type type
;
1825 struct bp_location
*loc
, **tmp
;
1826 int bitpos
= 0, bitsize
= 0;
1828 if (value_bitsize (v
) != 0)
1830 /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield
1832 bitpos
= value_bitpos (v
);
1833 bitsize
= value_bitsize (v
);
1835 else if (v
== result
&& b
->val_bitsize
!= 0)
1837 /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield
1838 lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields
1839 VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */
1840 bitpos
= b
->val_bitpos
;
1841 bitsize
= b
->val_bitsize
;
1844 addr
= value_address (v
);
1847 /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */
1852 if (b
->type
== bp_read_watchpoint
)
1854 else if (b
->type
== bp_access_watchpoint
)
1857 loc
= allocate_bp_location (b
);
1858 for (tmp
= &(b
->loc
); *tmp
!= NULL
; tmp
= &((*tmp
)->next
))
1861 loc
->gdbarch
= get_type_arch (value_type (v
));
1863 loc
->pspace
= frame_pspace
;
1864 loc
->address
= address_significant (loc
->gdbarch
, addr
);
1868 /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */
1869 loc
->length
= ((bitpos
% 8) + bitsize
+ 7) / 8;
1872 loc
->length
= TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v
));
1874 loc
->watchpoint_type
= type
;
1879 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
1880 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
1881 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
1886 enum bp_loc_type loc_type
;
1887 struct bp_location
*bl
;
1889 reg_cnt
= can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain
);
1893 int i
, target_resources_ok
, other_type_used
;
1896 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
1897 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
1898 b
->exact
= target_exact_watchpoints
&& reg_cnt
== 1;
1900 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
1901 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
1902 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
1903 this watchpoint in as well. */
1905 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
1906 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
1907 hardware watchpoint type. */
1909 if (type
== bp_watchpoint
)
1910 type
= bp_hardware_watchpoint
;
1912 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
1913 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
1914 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
1915 through watch_command), so always account for it
1918 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
1919 i
= hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (b
, type
, &other_type_used
);
1921 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
1922 i
+= hw_watchpoint_use_count (b
);
1925 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type
, i
, other_type_used
);
1926 if (target_resources_ok
<= 0)
1928 int sw_mode
= b
->ops
->works_in_software_mode (b
);
1930 if (target_resources_ok
== 0 && !sw_mode
)
1931 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
1932 "hardware watchpoint."));
1933 else if (target_resources_ok
< 0 && !sw_mode
)
1934 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
1935 "resources for this watchpoint."));
1937 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
1938 b
->type
= bp_watchpoint
;
1942 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
1943 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
1944 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
1949 else if (!b
->ops
->works_in_software_mode (b
))
1951 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints
)
1952 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1953 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1955 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
1956 "read/access watchpoint."));
1959 b
->type
= bp_watchpoint
;
1961 loc_type
= (b
->type
== bp_watchpoint
? bp_loc_other
1962 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
);
1963 for (bl
= b
->loc
; bl
; bl
= bl
->next
)
1964 bl
->loc_type
= loc_type
;
1967 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
1968 above left it without any location set up. But,
1969 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
1970 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
1971 if (b
->type
== bp_watchpoint
&& b
->loc
== NULL
)
1972 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (b
, frame_pspace
);
1974 else if (!within_current_scope
)
1976 printf_filtered (_("\
1977 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
1978 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1980 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b
);
1983 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1985 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id
));
1989 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1990 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
1991 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
1992 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
1993 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
1995 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location
*bl
)
1997 if (bl
->owner
== NULL
|| !breakpoint_enabled (bl
->owner
))
2000 if (bl
->owner
->disposition
== disp_del_at_next_stop
)
2003 if (!bl
->enabled
|| bl
->shlib_disabled
|| bl
->duplicate
)
2006 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl
->owner
) && bl
->pspace
->executing_startup
)
2009 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
2010 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
2011 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
2012 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
2013 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
2014 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
2015 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
2016 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
2017 if (bl
->pspace
->breakpoints_not_allowed
)
2020 /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
2021 location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint,
2022 and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past
2024 if ((bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2025 || bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
)
2026 && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl
->pspace
->aspace
,
2028 /* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location
2029 we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself.
2030 However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may
2031 break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the
2032 instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags.
2033 We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction
2034 or switch to displaced stepping. */
2035 && !(bl
->owner
->type
== bp_single_step
2036 && thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl
->owner
->thread
)))
2038 infrun_debug_printf ("skipping breakpoint: stepping past insn at: %s",
2039 paddress (bl
->gdbarch
, bl
->address
));
2043 /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the
2044 instruction that triggered one. */
2045 if ((bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
)
2046 && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ())
2048 infrun_debug_printf ("stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. "
2049 "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d\n",
2050 paddress (bl
->gdbarch
, bl
->address
), bl
->length
);
2057 /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
2058 that the location is not duplicated. */
2061 unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location
*bl
)
2064 const int save_duplicate
= bl
->duplicate
;
2067 result
= should_be_inserted (bl
);
2068 bl
->duplicate
= save_duplicate
;
2072 /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2073 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2074 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2075 any error during parsing. */
2077 static agent_expr_up
2078 parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope
, struct expression
*cond
)
2083 agent_expr_up aexpr
;
2085 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2086 that may show up. */
2089 aexpr
= gen_eval_for_expr (scope
, cond
);
2092 catch (const gdb_exception_error
&ex
)
2094 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2095 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2096 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2099 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2103 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2104 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2105 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2106 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2107 one of them is true. */
2110 build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location
*bl
)
2112 struct bp_location
**locp
= NULL
, **loc2p
;
2113 int null_condition_or_parse_error
= 0;
2114 int modified
= bl
->needs_update
;
2115 struct bp_location
*loc
;
2117 /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
2118 bl
->target_info
.conditions
.clear ();
2120 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2121 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2122 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2124 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2125 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2128 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2129 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent
2130 expression bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to
2131 send conditions to the target since this location will always
2132 trigger and generate a response back to GDB. Note we consider
2133 all locations at the same address irrespective of type, i.e.,
2134 even if the locations aren't considered duplicates (e.g.,
2135 software breakpoint and hardware breakpoint at the same
2137 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p
, locp
, bl
->address
)
2140 if (is_breakpoint (loc
->owner
) && loc
->pspace
->num
== bl
->pspace
->num
)
2144 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2145 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2146 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2147 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2148 loc
->cond_bytecode
= parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl
->address
,
2152 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2153 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2154 if (!loc
->cond_bytecode
)
2156 null_condition_or_parse_error
= 1;
2162 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2163 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2164 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2166 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2167 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2168 if (null_condition_or_parse_error
)
2170 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p
, locp
, bl
->address
)
2173 if (is_breakpoint (loc
->owner
) && loc
->pspace
->num
== bl
->pspace
->num
)
2175 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2177 if (!loc
->cond_bytecode
)
2180 loc
->cond_bytecode
.reset ();
2185 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a
2186 condition list for this location's address. If we have software
2187 and hardware locations at the same address, they aren't
2188 considered duplicates, but we still marge all the conditions
2189 anyway, as it's simpler, and doesn't really make a practical
2191 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p
, locp
, bl
->address
)
2195 && is_breakpoint (loc
->owner
)
2196 && loc
->pspace
->num
== bl
->pspace
->num
2197 && loc
->owner
->enable_state
== bp_enabled
2200 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later
2201 to send the conditions to the target. */
2202 bl
->target_info
.conditions
.push_back (loc
->cond_bytecode
.get ());
2209 /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
2210 bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
2211 Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
2213 static agent_expr_up
2214 parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope
, char *cmd
)
2216 const char *cmdrest
;
2217 const char *format_start
, *format_end
;
2218 struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
= get_current_arch ();
2225 if (*cmdrest
== ',')
2227 cmdrest
= skip_spaces (cmdrest
);
2229 if (*cmdrest
++ != '"')
2230 error (_("No format string following the location"));
2232 format_start
= cmdrest
;
2234 format_pieces
fpieces (&cmdrest
);
2236 format_end
= cmdrest
;
2238 if (*cmdrest
++ != '"')
2239 error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
2241 cmdrest
= skip_spaces (cmdrest
);
2243 if (!(*cmdrest
== ',' || *cmdrest
== '\0'))
2244 error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
2246 if (*cmdrest
== ',')
2248 cmdrest
= skip_spaces (cmdrest
);
2250 /* For each argument, make an expression. */
2252 std::vector
<struct expression
*> argvec
;
2253 while (*cmdrest
!= '\0')
2258 expression_up expr
= parse_exp_1 (&cmd1
, scope
, block_for_pc (scope
), 1);
2259 argvec
.push_back (expr
.release ());
2261 if (*cmdrest
== ',')
2265 agent_expr_up aexpr
;
2267 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2268 that may show up. */
2271 aexpr
= gen_printf (scope
, gdbarch
, 0, 0,
2272 format_start
, format_end
- format_start
,
2273 argvec
.size (), argvec
.data ());
2275 catch (const gdb_exception_error
&ex
)
2277 /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
2278 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2279 It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
2282 /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
2286 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
2287 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
2288 different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
2291 build_target_command_list (struct bp_location
*bl
)
2293 struct bp_location
**locp
= NULL
, **loc2p
;
2294 int null_command_or_parse_error
= 0;
2295 int modified
= bl
->needs_update
;
2296 struct bp_location
*loc
;
2298 /* Clear commands left over from a previous insert. */
2299 bl
->target_info
.tcommands
.clear ();
2301 if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
2304 /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
2305 if (dprintf_style
!= dprintf_style_agent
)
2308 /* For now, if we have any location at the same address that isn't a
2309 dprintf, don't install the target-side commands, as that would
2310 make the breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
2312 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p
, locp
, bl
->address
)
2315 if (is_breakpoint (loc
->owner
)
2316 && loc
->pspace
->num
== bl
->pspace
->num
2317 && loc
->owner
->type
!= bp_dprintf
)
2321 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2322 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2323 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2324 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2325 response back to GDB. */
2326 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p
, locp
, bl
->address
)
2329 if (is_breakpoint (loc
->owner
) && loc
->pspace
->num
== bl
->pspace
->num
)
2333 /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
2334 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
2335 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2336 need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
2338 = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl
->address
,
2339 loc
->owner
->extra_string
);
2342 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2343 went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
2344 if (!loc
->cmd_bytecode
)
2346 null_command_or_parse_error
= 1;
2352 /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
2354 if (null_command_or_parse_error
)
2356 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p
, locp
, bl
->address
)
2359 if (is_breakpoint (loc
->owner
)
2360 && loc
->pspace
->num
== bl
->pspace
->num
)
2362 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2364 if (loc
->cmd_bytecode
== NULL
)
2367 loc
->cmd_bytecode
.reset ();
2372 /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command
2373 list for all duplicate locations at this location's address.
2374 Note that here we must care for whether the breakpoint location
2375 types are considered duplicates, otherwise, say, if we have a
2376 software and hardware location at the same address, the target
2377 could end up running the commands twice. For the moment, we only
2378 support targets-side commands with dprintf, but it doesn't hurt
2379 to be pedantically correct in case that changes. */
2380 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p
, locp
, bl
->address
)
2383 if (breakpoint_locations_match (bl
, loc
)
2384 && loc
->owner
->extra_string
2385 && is_breakpoint (loc
->owner
)
2386 && loc
->pspace
->num
== bl
->pspace
->num
2387 && loc
->owner
->enable_state
== bp_enabled
2390 /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
2391 to send the commands to the target. */
2392 bl
->target_info
.tcommands
.push_back (loc
->cmd_bytecode
.get ());
2396 bl
->target_info
.persist
= 0;
2397 /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
2398 if (bl
->owner
->type
== bp_dprintf
&& disconnected_dprintf
)
2399 bl
->target_info
.persist
= 1;
2402 /* Return the kind of breakpoint on address *ADDR. Get the kind
2403 of breakpoint according to ADDR except single-step breakpoint.
2404 Get the kind of single-step breakpoint according to the current
2408 breakpoint_kind (struct bp_location
*bl
, CORE_ADDR
*addr
)
2410 if (bl
->owner
->type
== bp_single_step
)
2412 struct thread_info
*thr
= find_thread_global_id (bl
->owner
->thread
);
2413 struct regcache
*regcache
;
2415 regcache
= get_thread_regcache (thr
);
2417 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_current_state (bl
->gdbarch
,
2421 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_pc (bl
->gdbarch
, addr
);
2424 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2425 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2426 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2427 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2430 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2431 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2433 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location
*bl
,
2434 struct ui_file
*tmp_error_stream
,
2435 int *disabled_breaks
,
2436 int *hw_breakpoint_error
,
2437 int *hw_bp_error_explained_already
)
2439 gdb_exception bp_excpt
;
2441 if (!should_be_inserted (bl
) || (bl
->inserted
&& !bl
->needs_update
))
2444 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2445 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2446 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2447 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2448 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2449 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2450 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2451 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2452 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2453 bl
->target_info
.reqstd_address
= bl
->address
;
2454 bl
->target_info
.placed_address_space
= bl
->pspace
->aspace
;
2455 bl
->target_info
.length
= bl
->length
;
2457 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2458 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2459 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2460 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2462 if (is_breakpoint (bl
->owner
))
2464 build_target_condition_list (bl
);
2465 build_target_command_list (bl
);
2466 /* Reset the modification marker. */
2467 bl
->needs_update
= 0;
2470 /* If "set breakpoint auto-hw" is "on" and a software breakpoint was
2471 set at a read-only address, then a breakpoint location will have
2472 been changed to hardware breakpoint before we get here. If it is
2473 "off" however, error out before actually trying to insert the
2474 breakpoint, with a nicer error message. */
2475 if (bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2476 && !automatic_hardware_breakpoints
)
2478 mem_region
*mr
= lookup_mem_region (bl
->address
);
2480 if (mr
!= nullptr && mr
->attrib
.mode
!= MEM_RW
)
2482 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream
,
2483 _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2484 "Cannot set software breakpoint "
2485 "at read-only address %s\n"),
2487 paddress (bl
->gdbarch
, bl
->address
));
2492 if (bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2493 || bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
)
2495 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2496 if (overlay_debugging
== ovly_off
2497 || bl
->section
== NULL
2498 || !(section_is_overlay (bl
->section
)))
2500 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2505 val
= bl
->owner
->ops
->insert_location (bl
);
2507 bp_excpt
= gdb_exception
{RETURN_ERROR
, GENERIC_ERROR
};
2509 catch (gdb_exception
&e
)
2511 bp_excpt
= std::move (e
);
2516 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2517 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2518 if (!overlay_events_enabled
)
2520 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2521 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2522 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2523 if (bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
)
2524 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2528 CORE_ADDR addr
= overlay_unmapped_address (bl
->address
,
2530 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2531 bl
->overlay_target_info
= bl
->target_info
;
2532 bl
->overlay_target_info
.reqstd_address
= addr
;
2534 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2539 bl
->overlay_target_info
.kind
2540 = breakpoint_kind (bl
, &addr
);
2541 bl
->overlay_target_info
.placed_address
= addr
;
2542 val
= target_insert_breakpoint (bl
->gdbarch
,
2543 &bl
->overlay_target_info
);
2546 = gdb_exception
{RETURN_ERROR
, GENERIC_ERROR
};
2548 catch (gdb_exception
&e
)
2550 bp_excpt
= std::move (e
);
2553 if (bp_excpt
.reason
!= 0)
2554 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream
,
2555 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2556 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2560 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2561 if (section_is_mapped (bl
->section
))
2563 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2568 val
= bl
->owner
->ops
->insert_location (bl
);
2570 bp_excpt
= gdb_exception
{RETURN_ERROR
, GENERIC_ERROR
};
2572 catch (gdb_exception
&e
)
2574 bp_excpt
= std::move (e
);
2579 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2580 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2585 if (bp_excpt
.reason
!= 0)
2587 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2589 /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
2590 breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
2591 removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
2592 event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
2593 breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
2594 breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
2595 doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
2596 errors as memory errors. */
2597 if (bp_excpt
.reason
== RETURN_ERROR
2598 && (bp_excpt
.error
== GENERIC_ERROR
2599 || bp_excpt
.error
== MEMORY_ERROR
)
2600 && bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2601 && (solib_name_from_address (bl
->pspace
, bl
->address
)
2602 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl
->pspace
,
2605 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2606 bl
->shlib_disabled
= 1;
2607 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified
.notify (bl
->owner
);
2608 if (!*disabled_breaks
)
2610 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream
,
2611 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2613 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream
,
2614 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2615 "library breakpoints:\n");
2617 *disabled_breaks
= 1;
2618 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream
,
2619 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl
->owner
->number
);
2624 if (bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
)
2626 *hw_breakpoint_error
= 1;
2627 *hw_bp_error_explained_already
= bp_excpt
.message
!= NULL
;
2628 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream
,
2629 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
2631 bp_excpt
.message
? ":" : ".\n");
2632 if (bp_excpt
.message
!= NULL
)
2633 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream
, "%s.\n",
2638 if (bp_excpt
.message
== NULL
)
2641 = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO
,
2642 bl
->gdbarch
, bl
->address
);
2644 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream
,
2645 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2647 bl
->owner
->number
, message
.c_str ());
2651 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream
,
2652 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
2667 else if (bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2668 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2669 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2670 && bl
->owner
->disposition
!= disp_del_at_next_stop
)
2674 gdb_assert (bl
->owner
->ops
!= NULL
2675 && bl
->owner
->ops
->insert_location
!= NULL
);
2677 val
= bl
->owner
->ops
->insert_location (bl
);
2679 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2680 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2681 if (val
== 1 && bl
->watchpoint_type
== hw_read
)
2683 struct bp_location
*loc
, **loc_temp
;
2685 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2686 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2688 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc
, loc_temp
)
2690 && loc
->watchpoint_type
== hw_access
2691 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl
, loc
))
2695 bl
->target_info
= loc
->target_info
;
2696 bl
->watchpoint_type
= hw_access
;
2703 bl
->watchpoint_type
= hw_access
;
2704 val
= bl
->owner
->ops
->insert_location (bl
);
2707 /* Back to the original value. */
2708 bl
->watchpoint_type
= hw_read
;
2712 bl
->inserted
= (val
== 0);
2715 else if (bl
->owner
->type
== bp_catchpoint
)
2719 gdb_assert (bl
->owner
->ops
!= NULL
2720 && bl
->owner
->ops
->insert_location
!= NULL
);
2722 val
= bl
->owner
->ops
->insert_location (bl
);
2725 bl
->owner
->enable_state
= bp_disabled
;
2729 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2730 of catchpoint."), bl
->owner
->number
);
2732 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl
->owner
->number
);
2735 bl
->inserted
= (val
== 0);
2737 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2738 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2739 so just return success. */
2746 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2747 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2751 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space
*pspace
)
2753 struct breakpoint
*b
, *b_temp
;
2754 struct bp_location
*loc
, **loc_temp
;
2756 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2757 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, b_temp
)
2759 if (b
->pspace
== pspace
)
2760 delete_breakpoint (b
);
2763 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2764 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2765 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc
, loc_temp
)
2767 struct bp_location
*tmp
;
2769 if (loc
->pspace
== pspace
)
2771 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2772 if (loc
->owner
->loc
== loc
)
2773 loc
->owner
->loc
= loc
->next
;
2775 for (tmp
= loc
->owner
->loc
; tmp
->next
!= NULL
; tmp
= tmp
->next
)
2776 if (tmp
->next
== loc
)
2778 tmp
->next
= loc
->next
;
2784 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
2785 removed locations above. */
2786 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT
);
2789 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
2790 Throws exception on any error.
2791 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
2792 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
2794 insert_breakpoints (void)
2796 struct breakpoint
*bpt
;
2798 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt
)
2799 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt
))
2801 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) bpt
;
2803 update_watchpoint (w
, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
2806 /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global
2807 location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and
2808 ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. Also,
2809 update_global_location_list tries to "upgrade" software
2810 breakpoints to hardware breakpoints to handle "set breakpoint
2811 auto-hw", so we need to call it even if we don't have new
2813 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT
);
2816 /* Invoke CALLBACK for each of bp_location. */
2819 iterate_over_bp_locations (walk_bp_location_callback callback
)
2821 struct bp_location
*loc
, **loc_tmp
;
2823 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc
, loc_tmp
)
2825 callback (loc
, NULL
);
2829 /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
2830 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
2831 always-inserted mode. */
2834 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
2836 struct bp_location
*bl
, **blp_tmp
;
2839 int disabled_breaks
= 0;
2840 int hw_breakpoint_error
= 0;
2841 int hw_bp_details_reported
= 0;
2843 string_file tmp_error_stream
;
2845 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2846 there was an error. */
2847 tmp_error_stream
.puts ("Warning:\n");
2849 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread
;
2851 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl
, blp_tmp
)
2853 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
2855 if (!is_breakpoint (bl
->owner
))
2858 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
2859 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
2860 deletion of breakpoints. */
2861 if (!bl
->inserted
|| !bl
->needs_update
)
2864 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl
->pspace
);
2866 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2867 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2868 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2869 insert breakpoints. */
2870 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2871 && (inferior_ptid
== null_ptid
|| !target_has_execution
))
2874 val
= insert_bp_location (bl
, &tmp_error_stream
, &disabled_breaks
,
2875 &hw_breakpoint_error
, &hw_bp_details_reported
);
2882 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
2883 error_stream (tmp_error_stream
);
2887 /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
2890 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
2892 struct breakpoint
*bpt
;
2893 struct bp_location
*bl
, **blp_tmp
;
2896 int disabled_breaks
= 0;
2897 int hw_breakpoint_error
= 0;
2898 int hw_bp_error_explained_already
= 0;
2900 string_file tmp_error_stream
;
2902 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2903 there was an error. */
2904 tmp_error_stream
.puts ("Warning:\n");
2906 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread
;
2908 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl
, blp_tmp
)
2910 if (!should_be_inserted (bl
) || (bl
->inserted
&& !bl
->needs_update
))
2913 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
2914 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
2915 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2916 if (bl
->owner
->thread
!= -1
2917 && !valid_global_thread_id (bl
->owner
->thread
))
2920 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl
->pspace
);
2922 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2923 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2924 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2925 insert breakpoints. */
2926 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2927 && (inferior_ptid
== null_ptid
|| !target_has_execution
))
2930 val
= insert_bp_location (bl
, &tmp_error_stream
, &disabled_breaks
,
2931 &hw_breakpoint_error
, &hw_bp_error_explained_already
);
2936 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
2937 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
2938 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt
)
2940 int some_failed
= 0;
2941 struct bp_location
*loc
;
2943 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt
))
2946 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt
))
2949 if (bpt
->disposition
== disp_del_at_next_stop
)
2952 for (loc
= bpt
->loc
; loc
; loc
= loc
->next
)
2953 if (!loc
->inserted
&& should_be_inserted (loc
))
2960 for (loc
= bpt
->loc
; loc
; loc
= loc
->next
)
2962 remove_breakpoint (loc
);
2964 hw_breakpoint_error
= 1;
2965 tmp_error_stream
.printf ("Could not insert "
2966 "hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
2974 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
2975 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
2976 if (hw_breakpoint_error
&& !hw_bp_error_explained_already
)
2978 tmp_error_stream
.printf ("Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
2979 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
2981 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
2982 error_stream (tmp_error_stream
);
2986 /* Used when the program stops.
2987 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
2988 removing a breakpoint location. */
2991 remove_breakpoints (void)
2993 struct bp_location
*bl
, **blp_tmp
;
2996 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl
, blp_tmp
)
2998 if (bl
->inserted
&& !is_tracepoint (bl
->owner
))
2999 val
|= remove_breakpoint (bl
);
3004 /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
3008 remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info
*tp
, int silent
)
3010 struct breakpoint
*b
, *b_tmp
;
3012 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, b_tmp
)
3014 if (b
->thread
== tp
->global_num
&& user_breakpoint_p (b
))
3016 b
->disposition
= disp_del_at_next_stop
;
3018 printf_filtered (_("\
3019 Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"),
3020 b
->number
, print_thread_id (tp
));
3022 /* Hide it from the user. */
3028 /* See breakpoint.h. */
3031 remove_breakpoints_inf (inferior
*inf
)
3033 struct bp_location
*bl
, **blp_tmp
;
3036 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl
, blp_tmp
)
3038 if (bl
->pspace
!= inf
->pspace
)
3041 if (bl
->inserted
&& !bl
->target_info
.persist
)
3043 val
= remove_breakpoint (bl
);
3050 static int internal_breakpoint_number
= -1;
3052 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
3053 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
3054 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
3055 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
3056 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
3057 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
3059 set_breakpoint_number (int internal
, struct breakpoint
*b
)
3062 b
->number
= internal_breakpoint_number
--;
3065 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count
+ 1);
3066 b
->number
= breakpoint_count
;
3070 static struct breakpoint
*
3071 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
3072 CORE_ADDR address
, enum bptype type
,
3073 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
)
3075 symtab_and_line sal
;
3077 sal
.section
= find_pc_overlay (sal
.pc
);
3078 sal
.pspace
= current_program_space
;
3080 breakpoint
*b
= set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch
, sal
, type
, ops
);
3081 b
->number
= internal_breakpoint_number
--;
3082 b
->disposition
= disp_donttouch
;
3087 static const char *const longjmp_names
[] =
3089 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
3091 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
3093 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
3094 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
3096 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
3097 struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym
{};
3099 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
3100 struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym
[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES
] {};
3102 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
3103 int longjmp_searched
= 0;
3105 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). These are non-owning
3107 std::vector
<probe
*> longjmp_probes
;
3109 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
3110 struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym
{};
3112 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
3113 struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym
{};
3115 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
3116 int exception_searched
= 0;
3118 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). These are non-owning
3120 std::vector
<probe
*> exception_probes
;
3123 static const struct objfile_key
<breakpoint_objfile_data
>
3124 breakpoint_objfile_key
;
3126 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
3127 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found
;
3129 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
3132 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol
*msym
)
3134 return msym
== &msym_not_found
;
3137 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
3138 Allocate the data if necessary. */
3140 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data
*
3141 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile
*objfile
)
3143 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
*bp_objfile_data
;
3145 bp_objfile_data
= breakpoint_objfile_key
.get (objfile
);
3146 if (bp_objfile_data
== NULL
)
3147 bp_objfile_data
= breakpoint_objfile_key
.emplace (objfile
);
3148 return bp_objfile_data
;
3152 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
3154 const char *const func_name
= "_ovly_debug_event";
3156 for (objfile
*objfile
: current_program_space
->objfiles ())
3158 struct breakpoint
*b
;
3159 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
*bp_objfile_data
;
3161 struct explicit_location explicit_loc
;
3163 bp_objfile_data
= get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile
);
3165 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data
->overlay_msym
.minsym
))
3168 if (bp_objfile_data
->overlay_msym
.minsym
== NULL
)
3170 struct bound_minimal_symbol m
;
3172 m
= lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name
, objfile
);
3173 if (m
.minsym
== NULL
)
3175 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
3176 bp_objfile_data
->overlay_msym
.minsym
= &msym_not_found
;
3179 bp_objfile_data
->overlay_msym
= m
;
3182 addr
= BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data
->overlay_msym
);
3183 b
= create_internal_breakpoint (objfile
->arch (), addr
,
3185 &internal_breakpoint_ops
);
3186 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc
);
3187 explicit_loc
.function_name
= ASTRDUP (func_name
);
3188 b
->location
= new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc
);
3190 if (overlay_debugging
== ovly_auto
)
3192 b
->enable_state
= bp_enabled
;
3193 overlay_events_enabled
= 1;
3197 b
->enable_state
= bp_disabled
;
3198 overlay_events_enabled
= 0;
3204 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
3206 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace
;
3208 for (struct program_space
*pspace
: program_spaces
)
3210 set_current_program_space (pspace
);
3212 for (objfile
*objfile
: current_program_space
->objfiles ())
3215 struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
;
3216 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
*bp_objfile_data
;
3218 gdbarch
= objfile
->arch ();
3220 bp_objfile_data
= get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile
);
3222 if (!bp_objfile_data
->longjmp_searched
)
3224 std::vector
<probe
*> ret
3225 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile
, "libc", "longjmp");
3229 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3232 if (!p
->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3234 /* We cannot use the probe interface here,
3235 because it does not know how to evaluate
3240 bp_objfile_data
->longjmp_probes
= ret
;
3241 bp_objfile_data
->longjmp_searched
= 1;
3244 if (!bp_objfile_data
->longjmp_probes
.empty ())
3246 for (probe
*p
: bp_objfile_data
->longjmp_probes
)
3248 struct breakpoint
*b
;
3250 b
= create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch
,
3251 p
->get_relocated_address (objfile
),
3253 &internal_breakpoint_ops
);
3254 b
->location
= new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
3255 b
->enable_state
= bp_disabled
;
3261 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch
))
3264 for (i
= 0; i
< NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES
; i
++)
3266 struct breakpoint
*b
;
3267 const char *func_name
;
3269 struct explicit_location explicit_loc
;
3271 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data
->longjmp_msym
[i
].minsym
))
3274 func_name
= longjmp_names
[i
];
3275 if (bp_objfile_data
->longjmp_msym
[i
].minsym
== NULL
)
3277 struct bound_minimal_symbol m
;
3279 m
= lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name
, objfile
);
3280 if (m
.minsym
== NULL
)
3282 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3283 bp_objfile_data
->longjmp_msym
[i
].minsym
= &msym_not_found
;
3286 bp_objfile_data
->longjmp_msym
[i
] = m
;
3289 addr
= BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data
->longjmp_msym
[i
]);
3290 b
= create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch
, addr
, bp_longjmp_master
,
3291 &internal_breakpoint_ops
);
3292 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc
);
3293 explicit_loc
.function_name
= ASTRDUP (func_name
);
3294 b
->location
= new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc
);
3295 b
->enable_state
= bp_disabled
;
3301 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3303 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3305 const char *const func_name
= "std::terminate()";
3307 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace
;
3309 for (struct program_space
*pspace
: program_spaces
)
3313 set_current_program_space (pspace
);
3315 for (objfile
*objfile
: current_program_space
->objfiles ())
3317 struct breakpoint
*b
;
3318 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
*bp_objfile_data
;
3319 struct explicit_location explicit_loc
;
3321 bp_objfile_data
= get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile
);
3323 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data
->terminate_msym
.minsym
))
3326 if (bp_objfile_data
->terminate_msym
.minsym
== NULL
)
3328 struct bound_minimal_symbol m
;
3330 m
= lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name
, NULL
, objfile
);
3331 if (m
.minsym
== NULL
|| (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m
.minsym
) != mst_text
3332 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m
.minsym
) != mst_file_text
))
3334 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3335 bp_objfile_data
->terminate_msym
.minsym
= &msym_not_found
;
3338 bp_objfile_data
->terminate_msym
= m
;
3341 addr
= BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data
->terminate_msym
);
3342 b
= create_internal_breakpoint (objfile
->arch (), addr
,
3343 bp_std_terminate_master
,
3344 &internal_breakpoint_ops
);
3345 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc
);
3346 explicit_loc
.function_name
= ASTRDUP (func_name
);
3347 b
->location
= new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc
);
3348 b
->enable_state
= bp_disabled
;
3353 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3356 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3358 const char *const func_name
= "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3360 for (objfile
*objfile
: current_program_space
->objfiles ())
3362 struct breakpoint
*b
;
3363 struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
;
3364 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
*bp_objfile_data
;
3366 struct explicit_location explicit_loc
;
3368 bp_objfile_data
= get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile
);
3370 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3371 if (!bp_objfile_data
->exception_searched
)
3373 std::vector
<probe
*> ret
3374 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile
, "libgcc", "unwind");
3378 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3381 if (!p
->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3383 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3384 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3388 bp_objfile_data
->exception_probes
= ret
;
3389 bp_objfile_data
->exception_searched
= 1;
3392 if (!bp_objfile_data
->exception_probes
.empty ())
3394 gdbarch
= objfile
->arch ();
3396 for (probe
*p
: bp_objfile_data
->exception_probes
)
3398 b
= create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch
,
3399 p
->get_relocated_address (objfile
),
3400 bp_exception_master
,
3401 &internal_breakpoint_ops
);
3402 b
->location
= new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3403 b
->enable_state
= bp_disabled
;
3409 /* Otherwise, try the hook function. */
3411 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data
->exception_msym
.minsym
))
3414 gdbarch
= objfile
->arch ();
3416 if (bp_objfile_data
->exception_msym
.minsym
== NULL
)
3418 struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook
;
3420 debug_hook
= lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name
, NULL
, objfile
);
3421 if (debug_hook
.minsym
== NULL
)
3423 bp_objfile_data
->exception_msym
.minsym
= &msym_not_found
;
3427 bp_objfile_data
->exception_msym
= debug_hook
;
3430 addr
= BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data
->exception_msym
);
3431 addr
= gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch
, addr
,
3432 current_top_target ());
3433 b
= create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch
, addr
, bp_exception_master
,
3434 &internal_breakpoint_ops
);
3435 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc
);
3436 explicit_loc
.function_name
= ASTRDUP (func_name
);
3437 b
->location
= new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc
);
3438 b
->enable_state
= bp_disabled
;
3442 /* Does B have a location spec? */
3445 breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (const struct breakpoint
*b
)
3447 return b
->location
!= NULL
&& event_location_empty_p (b
->location
.get ());
3451 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3453 struct breakpoint
*b
, *b_tmp
;
3454 struct bp_location
*bploc
, **bplocp_tmp
;
3456 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3457 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3458 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3459 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3460 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3461 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3462 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3463 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3464 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc
, bplocp_tmp
)
3465 if (bploc
->pspace
== current_program_space
)
3466 gdb_assert (!bploc
->inserted
);
3468 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, b_tmp
)
3470 if (b
->pspace
!= current_program_space
)
3473 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3474 if (b
->type
== bp_shlib_event
)
3476 delete_breakpoint (b
);
3480 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3481 if (b
->type
== bp_jit_event
)
3483 delete_breakpoint (b
);
3487 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3488 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3489 if (b
->type
== bp_thread_event
|| b
->type
== bp_overlay_event
3490 || b
->type
== bp_longjmp_master
|| b
->type
== bp_std_terminate_master
3491 || b
->type
== bp_exception_master
)
3493 delete_breakpoint (b
);
3497 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3498 if (b
->type
== bp_step_resume
|| b
->type
== bp_hp_step_resume
)
3500 delete_breakpoint (b
);
3504 /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */
3505 if (b
->type
== bp_single_step
)
3507 delete_breakpoint (b
);
3511 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3513 if (b
->type
== bp_longjmp
|| b
->type
== bp_longjmp_resume
3514 || b
->type
== bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3515 || b
->type
== bp_exception
|| b
->type
== bp_exception_resume
)
3517 delete_breakpoint (b
);
3521 if (b
->type
== bp_catchpoint
)
3523 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3524 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3525 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3526 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3530 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3531 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3532 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3533 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3534 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3535 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3537 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3538 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3539 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3540 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3541 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3542 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3543 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3545 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3546 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3547 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3548 let finish_command delete it.
3550 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3551 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3552 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3553 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3554 solib breakpoints.) */
3556 if (b
->type
== bp_finish
)
3561 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3562 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3564 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b
))
3566 delete_breakpoint (b
);
3573 detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid
)
3575 struct bp_location
*bl
, **blp_tmp
;
3577 scoped_restore save_inferior_ptid
= make_scoped_restore (&inferior_ptid
);
3578 struct inferior
*inf
= current_inferior ();
3580 if (ptid
.pid () == inferior_ptid
.pid ())
3581 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3583 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3584 inferior_ptid
= ptid
;
3585 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl
, blp_tmp
)
3587 if (bl
->pspace
!= inf
->pspace
)
3590 /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
3591 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
3592 package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
3593 maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
3594 these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
3595 would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
3596 if (bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_other
)
3600 val
|= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl
, DETACH_BREAKPOINT
);
3606 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3607 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3608 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3609 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3610 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3613 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location
*bl
, enum remove_bp_reason reason
)
3617 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3618 gdb_assert (bl
->owner
!= NULL
);
3620 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3621 This should not ever happen. */
3622 gdb_assert (bl
->owner
->type
!= bp_none
);
3624 if (bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3625 || bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
)
3627 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3628 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3629 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3631 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3632 if (overlay_debugging
== ovly_off
3633 || bl
->section
== NULL
3634 || !(section_is_overlay (bl
->section
)))
3636 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3638 /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
3639 know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
3640 shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
3641 removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
3642 "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
3643 whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
3644 breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
3645 about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
3646 add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
3647 list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
3648 breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
3649 breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
3650 is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
3651 code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
3652 breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
3653 implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
3654 being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
3655 they should always be removed. */
3656 if (bl
->shlib_disabled
3657 && bl
->target_info
.shadow_len
!= 0
3658 && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl
->gdbarch
, &bl
->target_info
))
3661 val
= bl
->owner
->ops
->remove_location (bl
, reason
);
3665 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3666 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3667 if (!overlay_events_enabled
)
3669 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3670 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
3672 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
3673 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
3674 if (bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
)
3675 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl
->gdbarch
,
3676 &bl
->overlay_target_info
);
3678 target_remove_breakpoint (bl
->gdbarch
,
3679 &bl
->overlay_target_info
,
3682 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
3683 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
3686 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
3687 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
3688 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
3689 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
3691 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
3692 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
3693 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
3694 if (bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
3695 || section_is_mapped (bl
->section
))
3696 val
= bl
->owner
->ops
->remove_location (bl
, reason
);
3702 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
3707 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
3708 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
3709 not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
3710 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
3711 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
3712 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
3713 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
3714 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
3715 always-inserted mode. */
3717 && (bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3718 && (bl
->shlib_disabled
3719 || solib_name_from_address (bl
->pspace
, bl
->address
)
3720 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl
->pspace
,
3726 bl
->inserted
= (reason
== DETACH_BREAKPOINT
);
3728 else if (bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
)
3730 gdb_assert (bl
->owner
->ops
!= NULL
3731 && bl
->owner
->ops
->remove_location
!= NULL
);
3733 bl
->inserted
= (reason
== DETACH_BREAKPOINT
);
3734 bl
->owner
->ops
->remove_location (bl
, reason
);
3736 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
3737 if (reason
== REMOVE_BREAKPOINT
&& bl
->inserted
)
3738 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
3741 else if (bl
->owner
->type
== bp_catchpoint
3742 && breakpoint_enabled (bl
->owner
)
3745 gdb_assert (bl
->owner
->ops
!= NULL
3746 && bl
->owner
->ops
->remove_location
!= NULL
);
3748 val
= bl
->owner
->ops
->remove_location (bl
, reason
);
3752 bl
->inserted
= (reason
== DETACH_BREAKPOINT
);
3759 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location
*bl
)
3761 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3762 gdb_assert (bl
->owner
!= NULL
);
3764 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3765 This should not ever happen. */
3766 gdb_assert (bl
->owner
->type
!= bp_none
);
3768 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread
;
3770 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl
->pspace
);
3772 return remove_breakpoint_1 (bl
, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT
);
3775 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
3778 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
3780 struct bp_location
*bl
, **blp_tmp
;
3782 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl
, blp_tmp
)
3783 if (bl
->pspace
== current_program_space
)
3787 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
3788 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
3790 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
3793 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
3794 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
3795 init_wait_for_inferior). */
3800 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context
)
3802 struct breakpoint
*b
, *b_tmp
;
3803 struct program_space
*pspace
= current_program_space
;
3805 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
3807 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
3810 mark_breakpoints_out ();
3812 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, b_tmp
)
3814 if (b
->loc
&& b
->loc
->pspace
!= pspace
)
3820 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy
:
3822 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
3823 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
3826 case bp_watchpoint_scope
:
3828 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
3830 case bp_shlib_event
:
3832 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
3833 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
3834 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
3835 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
3836 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
3838 (gdb) file prog-linux
3839 (gdb) run # native linux target
3842 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
3843 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
3846 case bp_step_resume
:
3848 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
3850 case bp_single_step
:
3852 /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */
3854 delete_breakpoint (b
);
3858 case bp_hardware_watchpoint
:
3859 case bp_read_watchpoint
:
3860 case bp_access_watchpoint
:
3862 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) b
;
3864 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
3865 if (w
->exp_valid_block
!= NULL
)
3866 delete_breakpoint (b
);
3869 /* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer
3870 valid. New ones will be created in
3871 update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted.
3872 The next update_global_location_list call will
3873 garbage collect them. */
3876 if (context
== inf_starting
)
3878 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
3879 insert_breakpoints. */
3880 w
->val
.reset (nullptr);
3881 w
->val_valid
= false;
3891 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
3892 for (bp_location
*bl
: moribund_locations
)
3893 decref_bp_location (&bl
);
3894 moribund_locations
.clear ();
3897 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
3898 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
3899 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
3900 match, not program space. */
3902 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
3903 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
3904 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
3905 permanent breakpoint.
3906 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
3907 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
3908 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
3909 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
3910 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
3912 enum breakpoint_here
3913 breakpoint_here_p (const address_space
*aspace
, CORE_ADDR pc
)
3915 struct bp_location
*bl
, **blp_tmp
;
3916 int any_breakpoint_here
= 0;
3918 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl
, blp_tmp
)
3920 if (bl
->loc_type
!= bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3921 && bl
->loc_type
!= bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
)
3924 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
3925 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl
->owner
)
3927 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl
, aspace
, pc
))
3929 if (overlay_debugging
3930 && section_is_overlay (bl
->section
)
3931 && !section_is_mapped (bl
->section
))
3932 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
3933 else if (bl
->permanent
)
3934 return permanent_breakpoint_here
;
3936 any_breakpoint_here
= 1;
3940 return any_breakpoint_here
? ordinary_breakpoint_here
: no_breakpoint_here
;
3943 /* See breakpoint.h. */
3946 breakpoint_in_range_p (const address_space
*aspace
,
3947 CORE_ADDR addr
, ULONGEST len
)
3949 struct bp_location
*bl
, **blp_tmp
;
3951 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl
, blp_tmp
)
3953 if (bl
->loc_type
!= bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3954 && bl
->loc_type
!= bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
)
3957 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl
->owner
)
3959 && breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl
, aspace
,
3962 if (overlay_debugging
3963 && section_is_overlay (bl
->section
)
3964 && !section_is_mapped (bl
->section
))
3966 /* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match. */
3977 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
3980 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (const address_space
*aspace
, CORE_ADDR pc
)
3982 for (bp_location
*loc
: moribund_locations
)
3983 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc
, aspace
, pc
))
3989 /* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space
3993 bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location
*bl
,
3994 const address_space
*aspace
, CORE_ADDR pc
)
3997 && breakpoint_address_match (bl
->pspace
->aspace
, bl
->address
,
4000 if (overlay_debugging
4001 && section_is_overlay (bl
->section
)
4002 && !section_is_mapped (bl
->section
))
4003 return 0; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4010 /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4013 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space
*aspace
, CORE_ADDR pc
)
4015 struct bp_location
**blp
, **blp_tmp
= NULL
;
4017 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp
, blp_tmp
, pc
)
4019 struct bp_location
*bl
= *blp
;
4021 if (bl
->loc_type
!= bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4022 && bl
->loc_type
!= bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
)
4025 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl
, aspace
, pc
))
4031 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
4035 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space
*aspace
,
4038 struct bp_location
**blp
, **blp_tmp
= NULL
;
4040 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp
, blp_tmp
, pc
)
4042 struct bp_location
*bl
= *blp
;
4044 if (bl
->loc_type
!= bp_loc_software_breakpoint
)
4047 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl
, aspace
, pc
))
4054 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4057 hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space
*aspace
,
4060 struct bp_location
**blp
, **blp_tmp
= NULL
;
4062 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp
, blp_tmp
, pc
)
4064 struct bp_location
*bl
= *blp
;
4066 if (bl
->loc_type
!= bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
)
4069 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl
, aspace
, pc
))
4077 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (const address_space
*aspace
,
4078 CORE_ADDR addr
, ULONGEST len
)
4080 struct breakpoint
*bpt
;
4082 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt
)
4084 struct bp_location
*loc
;
4086 if (bpt
->type
!= bp_hardware_watchpoint
4087 && bpt
->type
!= bp_access_watchpoint
)
4090 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt
))
4093 for (loc
= bpt
->loc
; loc
; loc
= loc
->next
)
4094 if (loc
->pspace
->aspace
== aspace
&& loc
->inserted
)
4098 /* Check for intersection. */
4099 l
= std::max
<CORE_ADDR
> (loc
->address
, addr
);
4100 h
= std::min
<CORE_ADDR
> (loc
->address
+ loc
->length
, addr
+ len
);
4108 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4111 is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint
*b
)
4113 return (b
->type
== bp_catchpoint
);
4116 /* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
4119 bpstats::~bpstats ()
4121 if (bp_location_at
!= NULL
)
4122 decref_bp_location (&bp_location_at
);
4125 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
4126 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
4129 bpstat_clear (bpstat
*bsp
)
4146 bpstats::bpstats (const bpstats
&other
)
4148 bp_location_at (other
.bp_location_at
),
4149 breakpoint_at (other
.breakpoint_at
),
4150 commands (other
.commands
),
4151 print (other
.print
),
4153 print_it (other
.print_it
)
4155 if (other
.old_val
!= NULL
)
4156 old_val
= release_value (value_copy (other
.old_val
.get ()));
4157 incref_bp_location (bp_location_at
);
4160 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
4161 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
4164 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs
)
4168 bpstat retval
= NULL
;
4173 for (; bs
!= NULL
; bs
= bs
->next
)
4175 tmp
= new bpstats (*bs
);
4178 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
4188 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
4191 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp
, struct breakpoint
*breakpoint
)
4196 for (; bsp
!= NULL
; bsp
= bsp
->next
)
4198 if (bsp
->breakpoint_at
== breakpoint
)
4204 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4207 bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp
, enum gdb_signal sig
)
4209 for (; bsp
!= NULL
; bsp
= bsp
->next
)
4211 if (bsp
->breakpoint_at
== NULL
)
4213 /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
4215 if (sig
== GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP
)
4220 if (bsp
->breakpoint_at
->ops
->explains_signal (bsp
->breakpoint_at
,
4229 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
4230 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
4231 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
4232 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
4234 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
4235 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
4237 Return 1 otherwise. */
4240 bpstat_num (bpstat
*bsp
, int *num
)
4242 struct breakpoint
*b
;
4245 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
4247 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
4248 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
4249 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
4250 b
= (*bsp
)->breakpoint_at
;
4251 *bsp
= (*bsp
)->next
;
4253 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
4255 *num
= b
->number
; /* We have its number */
4259 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4262 bpstat_clear_actions (void)
4266 if (inferior_ptid
== null_ptid
)
4269 thread_info
*tp
= inferior_thread ();
4270 for (bs
= tp
->control
.stop_bpstat
; bs
!= NULL
; bs
= bs
->next
)
4272 bs
->commands
= NULL
;
4273 bs
->old_val
.reset (nullptr);
4277 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
4280 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
4282 if (inferior_ptid
!= null_ptid
)
4284 struct thread_info
*tp
= inferior_thread ();
4286 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
4287 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
4288 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
4289 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
4290 if (tp
->control
.in_infcall
)
4294 breakpoint_proceeded
= 1;
4297 /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
4298 or its equivalent. */
4301 command_line_is_silent (struct command_line
*cmd
)
4303 return cmd
&& (strcmp ("silent", cmd
->line
) == 0);
4306 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
4307 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
4308 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
4309 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
4311 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
4312 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
4313 bpstat of the current thread. */
4316 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat
*bsp
)
4321 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4323 if (executing_breakpoint_commands
)
4326 scoped_restore save_executing
4327 = make_scoped_restore (&executing_breakpoint_commands
, 1);
4329 scoped_restore preventer
= prevent_dont_repeat ();
4331 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4334 breakpoint_proceeded
= 0;
4335 for (; bs
!= NULL
; bs
= bs
->next
)
4337 struct command_line
*cmd
= NULL
;
4339 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4341 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4342 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4343 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4344 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4345 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4346 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4347 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4348 the tree when we're done. */
4349 counted_command_line ccmd
= bs
->commands
;
4350 bs
->commands
= NULL
;
4353 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd
))
4355 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4361 execute_control_command (cmd
);
4363 if (breakpoint_proceeded
)
4369 if (breakpoint_proceeded
)
4371 if (current_ui
->async
)
4372 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4373 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4374 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4377 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4378 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4379 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4380 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4381 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4382 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4383 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4384 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4385 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4386 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4387 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4388 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4389 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4397 /* Helper for bpstat_do_actions. Get the current thread, if there's
4398 one, is alive and has execution. Return NULL otherwise. */
4400 static thread_info
*
4401 get_bpstat_thread ()
4403 if (inferior_ptid
== null_ptid
|| !target_has_execution
)
4406 thread_info
*tp
= inferior_thread ();
4407 if (tp
->state
== THREAD_EXITED
|| tp
->executing
)
4413 bpstat_do_actions (void)
4415 auto cleanup_if_error
= make_scope_exit (bpstat_clear_actions
);
4418 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4419 while ((tp
= get_bpstat_thread ()) != NULL
)
4421 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the
4422 inferior, and only return when it is stopped at the next
4423 breakpoint, we keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns
4424 false to indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4425 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tp
->control
.stop_bpstat
))
4429 cleanup_if_error
.release ();
4432 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4435 watchpoint_value_print (struct value
*val
, struct ui_file
*stream
)
4438 fprintf_styled (stream
, metadata_style
.style (), _("<unreadable>"));
4441 struct value_print_options opts
;
4442 get_user_print_options (&opts
);
4443 value_print (val
, stream
, &opts
);
4447 /* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if
4448 debugging multiple threads. */
4451 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out
*uiout
)
4453 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
4458 if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ())
4461 struct thread_info
*thr
= inferior_thread ();
4463 uiout
->text ("Thread ");
4464 uiout
->field_string ("thread-id", print_thread_id (thr
));
4466 name
= thr
->name
!= NULL
? thr
->name
: target_thread_name (thr
);
4469 uiout
->text (" \"");
4470 uiout
->field_string ("name", name
);
4474 uiout
->text (" hit ");
4478 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4479 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4480 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4481 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4484 static enum print_stop_action
4485 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs
)
4487 switch (bs
->print_it
)
4490 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4491 return PRINT_UNKNOWN
;
4495 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4496 relevant messages. */
4497 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
;
4500 case print_it_normal
:
4502 struct breakpoint
*b
= bs
->breakpoint_at
;
4504 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4505 which has since been deleted. */
4507 return PRINT_UNKNOWN
;
4509 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4510 return b
->ops
->print_it (bs
);
4515 internal_error (__FILE__
, __LINE__
,
4516 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4521 /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4524 print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint
)
4526 bool any_deleted
= !current_program_space
->deleted_solibs
.empty ();
4527 bool any_added
= !current_program_space
->added_solibs
.empty ();
4531 if (any_added
|| any_deleted
)
4532 current_uiout
->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4534 current_uiout
->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4535 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4538 if (current_uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
4539 current_uiout
->field_string ("reason",
4540 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT
));
4544 current_uiout
->text (_(" Inferior unloaded "));
4545 ui_out_emit_list
list_emitter (current_uiout
, "removed");
4546 for (int ix
= 0; ix
< current_program_space
->deleted_solibs
.size (); ix
++)
4548 const std::string
&name
= current_program_space
->deleted_solibs
[ix
];
4551 current_uiout
->text (" ");
4552 current_uiout
->field_string ("library", name
);
4553 current_uiout
->text ("\n");
4559 current_uiout
->text (_(" Inferior loaded "));
4560 ui_out_emit_list
list_emitter (current_uiout
, "added");
4562 for (so_list
*iter
: current_program_space
->added_solibs
)
4565 current_uiout
->text (" ");
4567 current_uiout
->field_string ("library", iter
->so_name
);
4568 current_uiout
->text ("\n");
4573 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4574 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4575 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4576 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4577 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4578 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4579 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4582 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4583 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4584 code to print the location. An example is
4585 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4587 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4588 to also print the location part of the message.
4589 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4590 don't require a location appended to the end.
4591 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4592 further info to be printed. */
4594 enum print_stop_action
4595 bpstat_print (bpstat bs
, int kind
)
4597 enum print_stop_action val
;
4599 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4600 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4601 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4602 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4603 for (; bs
; bs
= bs
->next
)
4605 val
= print_bp_stop_message (bs
);
4606 if (val
== PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4607 || val
== PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4608 || val
== PRINT_NOTHING
)
4612 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4613 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4614 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4615 if (kind
== TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED
)
4617 print_solib_event (0);
4618 return PRINT_NOTHING
;
4621 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4622 with and nothing was printed. */
4623 return PRINT_UNKNOWN
;
4626 /* Evaluate the boolean expression EXP and return the result. */
4629 breakpoint_cond_eval (expression
*exp
)
4631 struct value
*mark
= value_mark ();
4632 bool res
= value_true (evaluate_expression (exp
));
4634 value_free_to_mark (mark
);
4638 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
4640 bpstats::bpstats (struct bp_location
*bl
, bpstat
**bs_link_pointer
)
4642 bp_location_at (bl
),
4643 breakpoint_at (bl
->owner
),
4647 print_it (print_it_normal
)
4649 incref_bp_location (bl
);
4650 **bs_link_pointer
= this;
4651 *bs_link_pointer
= &next
;
4656 bp_location_at (NULL
),
4657 breakpoint_at (NULL
),
4661 print_it (print_it_normal
)
4665 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
4666 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
4669 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus
*ws
)
4671 bool stopped_by_watchpoint
= target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
4673 struct breakpoint
*b
;
4675 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint
)
4677 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
4678 as not triggered. */
4680 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b
))
4682 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) b
;
4684 w
->watchpoint_triggered
= watch_triggered_no
;
4690 if (!target_stopped_data_address (current_top_target (), &addr
))
4692 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
4693 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
4695 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b
))
4697 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) b
;
4699 w
->watchpoint_triggered
= watch_triggered_unknown
;
4705 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
4706 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
4710 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b
))
4712 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) b
;
4713 struct bp_location
*loc
;
4715 w
->watchpoint_triggered
= watch_triggered_no
;
4716 for (loc
= b
->loc
; loc
; loc
= loc
->next
)
4718 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b
))
4720 CORE_ADDR newaddr
= addr
& w
->hw_wp_mask
;
4721 CORE_ADDR start
= loc
->address
& w
->hw_wp_mask
;
4723 if (newaddr
== start
)
4725 w
->watchpoint_triggered
= watch_triggered_yes
;
4729 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
4730 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (current_top_target (),
4734 w
->watchpoint_triggered
= watch_triggered_yes
;
4743 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check. */
4744 enum wp_check_result
4746 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
4749 /* The value has changed. */
4750 WP_VALUE_CHANGED
= 2,
4752 /* The value has not changed. */
4753 WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED
= 3,
4755 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
4759 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
4760 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
4762 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
4765 static wp_check_result
4766 watchpoint_check (bpstat bs
)
4768 struct watchpoint
*b
;
4769 struct frame_info
*fr
;
4770 int within_current_scope
;
4772 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
4773 gdb_assert (bs
->breakpoint_at
!= NULL
);
4774 b
= (struct watchpoint
*) bs
->breakpoint_at
;
4776 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
4777 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
4778 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
4779 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b
))
4782 if (b
->exp_valid_block
== NULL
)
4783 within_current_scope
= 1;
4786 struct frame_info
*frame
= get_current_frame ();
4787 struct gdbarch
*frame_arch
= get_frame_arch (frame
);
4788 CORE_ADDR frame_pc
= get_frame_pc (frame
);
4790 /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
4791 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
4792 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
4793 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
4794 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
4795 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
4796 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
4797 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
4798 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
4799 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch
, frame_pc
))
4802 fr
= frame_find_by_id (b
->watchpoint_frame
);
4803 within_current_scope
= (fr
!= NULL
);
4805 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
4806 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
4807 if (within_current_scope
)
4809 struct symbol
*function
;
4811 function
= get_frame_function (fr
);
4812 if (function
== NULL
4813 || !contained_in (b
->exp_valid_block
,
4814 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function
)))
4815 within_current_scope
= 0;
4818 if (within_current_scope
)
4819 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
4820 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
4825 if (within_current_scope
)
4827 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
4828 time before we return to the command level and call
4829 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
4830 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
4834 struct value
*new_val
;
4836 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b
))
4837 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
4838 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
4839 a mask watchpoint. */
4840 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED
;
4842 mark
= value_mark ();
4843 fetch_subexp_value (b
->exp
.get (), &pc
, &new_val
, NULL
, NULL
, 0);
4845 if (b
->val_bitsize
!= 0)
4846 new_val
= extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b
, new_val
);
4848 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
4849 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
4850 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
4851 not what we want. */
4852 if ((b
->val
!= NULL
) != (new_val
!= NULL
)
4853 || (b
->val
!= NULL
&& !value_equal_contents (b
->val
.get (),
4856 bs
->old_val
= b
->val
;
4857 b
->val
= release_value (new_val
);
4858 b
->val_valid
= true;
4859 if (new_val
!= NULL
)
4860 value_free_to_mark (mark
);
4861 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED
;
4865 /* Nothing changed. */
4866 value_free_to_mark (mark
);
4867 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED
;
4872 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
4873 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
4874 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
4875 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
4876 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
4877 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
4878 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
4879 the first value assigned). */
4880 /* We print all the stop information in
4881 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
4882 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
4883 already. So we have no choice but print the information
4886 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
4888 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
4890 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
4892 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE
));
4893 uiout
->message ("\nWatchpoint %pF deleted because the program has "
4894 "left the block in\n"
4895 "which its expression is valid.\n",
4896 signed_field ("wpnum", b
->number
));
4899 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
4901 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b
);
4907 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
4908 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
4909 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
4912 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location
*bl
,
4913 const address_space
*aspace
, CORE_ADDR bp_addr
,
4914 const struct target_waitstatus
*ws
)
4916 struct breakpoint
*b
= bl
->owner
;
4918 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
4919 gdb_assert (b
!= NULL
);
4921 return b
->ops
->breakpoint_hit (bl
, aspace
, bp_addr
, ws
);
4924 /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
4925 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
4928 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs
)
4930 const struct bp_location
*bl
;
4931 struct watchpoint
*b
;
4933 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
4934 bl
= bs
->bp_location_at
;
4935 gdb_assert (bl
!= NULL
);
4936 b
= (struct watchpoint
*) bs
->breakpoint_at
;
4937 gdb_assert (b
!= NULL
);
4940 int must_check_value
= 0;
4942 if (b
->type
== bp_watchpoint
)
4943 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
4945 must_check_value
= 1;
4946 else if (b
->watchpoint_triggered
== watch_triggered_yes
)
4947 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
4948 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
4950 must_check_value
= 1;
4951 else if (b
->watchpoint_triggered
== watch_triggered_unknown
4952 && b
->type
== bp_hardware_watchpoint
)
4953 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
4954 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
4955 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
4956 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
4957 must_check_value
= 1;
4959 if (must_check_value
)
4965 e
= watchpoint_check (bs
);
4967 catch (const gdb_exception
&ex
)
4969 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr
, ex
,
4970 "Error evaluating expression "
4971 "for watchpoint %d\n",
4974 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
4976 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"),
4979 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b
);
4986 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
4987 bs
->print_it
= print_it_done
;
4991 bs
->print_it
= print_it_noop
;
4994 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED
:
4995 if (b
->type
== bp_read_watchpoint
)
4997 /* There are two cases to consider here:
4999 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
5000 In that case, trust the target, and always report
5001 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
5002 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
5003 have changed since the last time it was read, and
5004 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
5005 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
5008 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
5009 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
5012 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
5013 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
5014 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
5015 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
5017 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
5018 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
5019 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
5022 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
5023 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
5024 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
5025 changes. This still gives false positives when
5026 the program writes the same value to memory as
5027 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
5028 it for a read), but it's much better than
5031 int other_write_watchpoint
= 0;
5033 if (bl
->watchpoint_type
== hw_read
)
5035 struct breakpoint
*other_b
;
5037 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b
)
5038 if (other_b
->type
== bp_hardware_watchpoint
5039 || other_b
->type
== bp_access_watchpoint
)
5041 struct watchpoint
*other_w
=
5042 (struct watchpoint
*) other_b
;
5044 if (other_w
->watchpoint_triggered
5045 == watch_triggered_yes
)
5047 other_write_watchpoint
= 1;
5053 if (other_write_watchpoint
5054 || bl
->watchpoint_type
== hw_access
)
5056 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
5057 and the value changed since the last time we
5058 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
5060 bs
->print_it
= print_it_noop
;
5065 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED
:
5066 if (b
->type
== bp_hardware_watchpoint
5067 || b
->type
== bp_watchpoint
)
5069 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
5070 the value hasn't changed. */
5071 bs
->print_it
= print_it_noop
;
5081 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
5083 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
5084 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
5085 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
5086 anything for this watchpoint. */
5087 bs
->print_it
= print_it_noop
;
5093 /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
5094 check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
5095 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
5096 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
5099 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs
, thread_info
*thread
)
5101 const struct bp_location
*bl
;
5102 struct breakpoint
*b
;
5104 bool condition_result
= true;
5105 struct expression
*cond
;
5107 gdb_assert (bs
->stop
);
5109 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5110 bl
= bs
->bp_location_at
;
5111 gdb_assert (bl
!= NULL
);
5112 b
= bs
->breakpoint_at
;
5113 gdb_assert (b
!= NULL
);
5115 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
5116 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
5117 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
5119 if (frame_id_p (b
->frame_id
)
5120 && !frame_id_eq (b
->frame_id
, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
5126 /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
5127 evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
5129 if ((b
->thread
!= -1 && b
->thread
!= thread
->global_num
)
5130 || (b
->task
!= 0 && b
->task
!= ada_get_task_number (thread
)))
5136 /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
5138 bs
->stop
= breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b
);
5140 if (is_watchpoint (b
))
5142 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) b
;
5144 cond
= w
->cond_exp
.get ();
5147 cond
= bl
->cond
.get ();
5149 if (cond
&& b
->disposition
!= disp_del_at_next_stop
)
5151 int within_current_scope
= 1;
5152 struct watchpoint
* w
;
5154 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
5155 be a long time before we return to the command level and
5156 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
5157 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
5159 struct value
*mark
= value_mark ();
5161 if (is_watchpoint (b
))
5162 w
= (struct watchpoint
*) b
;
5166 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
5167 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
5168 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
5169 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
5170 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
5172 if (w
== NULL
|| w
->cond_exp_valid_block
== NULL
)
5173 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
5176 struct frame_info
*frame
;
5178 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
5179 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
5180 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
5181 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
5182 really matter which instantiation of the function
5183 where the condition makes sense triggers the
5184 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
5185 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
5186 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
5187 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
5188 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
5189 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
5190 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
5192 frame
= block_innermost_frame (w
->cond_exp_valid_block
);
5194 select_frame (frame
);
5196 within_current_scope
= 0;
5198 if (within_current_scope
)
5202 condition_result
= breakpoint_cond_eval (cond
);
5204 catch (const gdb_exception
&ex
)
5206 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr
, ex
,
5207 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n");
5212 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
5213 "in the current scope"));
5214 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
5215 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
5217 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
5218 value_free_to_mark (mark
);
5221 if (cond
&& !condition_result
)
5225 else if (b
->ignore_count
> 0)
5229 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
5231 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified
.notify (b
);
5235 /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type
5236 on the current target. */
5239 need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location
*loc
)
5241 return ((loc
->loc_type
== bp_loc_software_breakpoint
5242 && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ())
5243 || (loc
->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5244 && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()));
5247 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5250 build_bpstat_chain (const address_space
*aspace
, CORE_ADDR bp_addr
,
5251 const struct target_waitstatus
*ws
)
5253 struct breakpoint
*b
;
5254 bpstat bs_head
= NULL
, *bs_link
= &bs_head
;
5258 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b
))
5261 for (bp_location
*bl
= b
->loc
; bl
!= NULL
; bl
= bl
->next
)
5263 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
5264 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
5265 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
5266 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
5267 checked all locations already. */
5268 if (b
->type
== bp_hardware_watchpoint
&& bl
!= b
->loc
)
5271 if (!bl
->enabled
|| bl
->shlib_disabled
)
5274 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl
, aspace
, bp_addr
, ws
))
5277 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
5280 bpstat bs
= new bpstats (bl
, &bs_link
); /* Alloc a bpstat to
5283 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
5284 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
5285 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
5289 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
5290 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
5291 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
5293 if (b
->type
== bp_watchpoint_scope
&& b
->related_breakpoint
!= b
)
5295 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) b
->related_breakpoint
;
5297 w
->watchpoint_triggered
= watch_triggered_yes
;
5302 /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */
5303 if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()
5304 || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())
5306 for (bp_location
*loc
: moribund_locations
)
5308 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc
, aspace
, bp_addr
)
5309 && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc
))
5311 bpstat bs
= new bpstats (loc
, &bs_link
);
5312 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
5315 bs
->print_it
= print_it_noop
;
5323 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5326 bpstat_stop_status (const address_space
*aspace
,
5327 CORE_ADDR bp_addr
, thread_info
*thread
,
5328 const struct target_waitstatus
*ws
,
5331 struct breakpoint
*b
= NULL
;
5332 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
5333 bpstat bs_head
= stop_chain
;
5335 int need_remove_insert
;
5338 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
5339 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
5340 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
5341 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
5342 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
5343 inferior function calls. */
5344 if (bs_head
== NULL
)
5345 bs_head
= build_bpstat_chain (aspace
, bp_addr
, ws
);
5347 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
5348 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
5349 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
5351 for (bs
= bs_head
; bs
!= NULL
; bs
= bs
->next
)
5353 if (bs
->breakpoint_at
&& bs
->breakpoint_at
->type
== bp_shlib_event
)
5355 handle_solib_event ();
5360 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
5361 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
5362 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
5366 for (bs
= bs_head
; bs
!= NULL
; bs
= bs
->next
)
5371 b
= bs
->breakpoint_at
;
5372 b
->ops
->check_status (bs
);
5375 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs
, thread
);
5380 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified
.notify (b
);
5382 /* We will stop here. */
5383 if (b
->disposition
== disp_disable
)
5385 --(b
->enable_count
);
5386 if (b
->enable_count
<= 0)
5387 b
->enable_state
= bp_disabled
;
5392 bs
->commands
= b
->commands
;
5393 if (command_line_is_silent (bs
->commands
5394 ? bs
->commands
.get () : NULL
))
5397 b
->ops
->after_condition_true (bs
);
5402 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5404 if (!bs
->stop
|| !bs
->print
)
5405 bs
->print_it
= print_it_noop
;
5408 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5409 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5410 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5412 need_remove_insert
= 0;
5413 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head
))
5414 for (bs
= bs_head
; bs
!= NULL
; bs
= bs
->next
)
5416 && bs
->breakpoint_at
5417 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs
->breakpoint_at
))
5419 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) bs
->breakpoint_at
;
5421 update_watchpoint (w
, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5422 need_remove_insert
= 1;
5425 if (need_remove_insert
)
5426 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT
);
5427 else if (removed_any
)
5428 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT
);
5434 handle_jit_event (void)
5436 struct frame_info
*frame
;
5437 struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
;
5439 infrun_debug_printf ("handling bp_jit_event");
5441 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5442 breakpoint_re_set. */
5443 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
5445 frame
= get_current_frame ();
5446 gdbarch
= get_frame_arch (frame
);
5447 objfile
*jiter
= symbol_objfile (get_frame_function (frame
));
5449 jit_event_handler (gdbarch
, jiter
);
5451 target_terminal::inferior ();
5454 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5456 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5459 bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head
)
5461 struct bpstat_what retval
;
5464 retval
.main_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING
;
5465 retval
.call_dummy
= STOP_NONE
;
5466 retval
.is_longjmp
= false;
5468 for (bs
= bs_head
; bs
!= NULL
; bs
= bs
->next
)
5470 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5471 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5472 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING
;
5475 if (bs
->breakpoint_at
== NULL
)
5477 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5478 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5482 bptype
= bs
->breakpoint_at
->type
;
5489 case bp_hardware_breakpoint
:
5490 case bp_single_step
:
5493 case bp_shlib_event
:
5497 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
;
5499 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT
;
5502 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
;
5505 case bp_hardware_watchpoint
:
5506 case bp_read_watchpoint
:
5507 case bp_access_watchpoint
:
5511 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
;
5513 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT
;
5517 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5518 This requires no further action. */
5522 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy
:
5526 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME
;
5527 retval
.is_longjmp
= bptype
!= bp_exception
;
5530 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
;
5532 case bp_longjmp_resume
:
5533 case bp_exception_resume
:
5536 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME
;
5537 retval
.is_longjmp
= bptype
== bp_longjmp_resume
;
5540 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
;
5542 case bp_step_resume
:
5544 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME
;
5547 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5548 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
;
5551 case bp_hp_step_resume
:
5553 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME
;
5556 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5557 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
;
5560 case bp_watchpoint_scope
:
5561 case bp_thread_event
:
5562 case bp_overlay_event
:
5563 case bp_longjmp_master
:
5564 case bp_std_terminate_master
:
5565 case bp_exception_master
:
5566 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
;
5572 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
;
5574 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT
;
5578 /* Some catchpoints are implemented with breakpoints.
5579 For those, we need to step over the breakpoint. */
5580 if (bs
->bp_location_at
->loc_type
!= bp_loc_other
)
5581 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
;
5585 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
;
5588 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5589 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5590 retval
.call_dummy
= STOP_STACK_DUMMY
;
5591 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT
;
5593 case bp_std_terminate
:
5594 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5595 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5596 retval
.call_dummy
= STOP_STD_TERMINATE
;
5597 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT
;
5600 case bp_fast_tracepoint
:
5601 case bp_static_tracepoint
:
5602 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5603 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5605 internal_error (__FILE__
, __LINE__
,
5606 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5608 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver
:
5609 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5610 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
;
5612 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return
:
5613 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5614 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5615 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING
;
5620 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT
;
5622 this_action
= BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
;
5626 internal_error (__FILE__
, __LINE__
,
5627 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype
);
5630 retval
.main_action
= std::max (retval
.main_action
, this_action
);
5637 bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat bs_head
)
5641 for (bs
= bs_head
; bs
!= NULL
; bs
= bs
->next
)
5643 struct breakpoint
*b
= bs
->breakpoint_at
;
5650 handle_jit_event ();
5652 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver
:
5653 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b
);
5655 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return
:
5656 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b
);
5662 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5665 bpstat_should_step ()
5667 struct breakpoint
*b
;
5670 if (breakpoint_enabled (b
) && b
->type
== bp_watchpoint
&& b
->loc
!= NULL
)
5675 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5678 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs
)
5680 for (; bs
!= NULL
; bs
= bs
->next
)
5689 /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
5690 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
5691 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
5694 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out
*uiout
, const char *col_name
)
5696 static char wrap_indent
[80];
5697 int i
, total_width
, width
, align
;
5701 for (i
= 1; uiout
->query_table_field (i
, &width
, &align
, &text
); i
++)
5703 if (strcmp (text
, col_name
) == 0)
5705 gdb_assert (total_width
< sizeof wrap_indent
);
5706 memset (wrap_indent
, ' ', total_width
);
5707 wrap_indent
[total_width
] = 0;
5712 total_width
+= width
+ 1;
5718 /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
5719 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
5721 "host": Host evals condition.
5722 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
5723 "target": Target evals condition.
5727 bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint
*b
)
5729 struct bp_location
*bl
;
5730 char host_evals
= 0;
5731 char target_evals
= 0;
5736 if (!is_breakpoint (b
))
5739 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5740 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5741 return condition_evaluation_host
;
5743 for (bl
= b
->loc
; bl
; bl
= bl
->next
)
5745 if (bl
->cond_bytecode
)
5751 if (host_evals
&& target_evals
)
5752 return condition_evaluation_both
;
5753 else if (target_evals
)
5754 return condition_evaluation_target
;
5756 return condition_evaluation_host
;
5759 /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
5760 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
5763 bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location
*bl
)
5765 if (bl
&& !is_breakpoint (bl
->owner
))
5768 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5769 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5770 return condition_evaluation_host
;
5772 if (bl
&& bl
->cond_bytecode
)
5773 return condition_evaluation_target
;
5775 return condition_evaluation_host
;
5778 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
5781 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint
*b
,
5782 struct bp_location
*loc
)
5784 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
5786 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace
;
5788 if (loc
!= NULL
&& loc
->shlib_disabled
)
5792 set_current_program_space (loc
->pspace
);
5794 if (b
->display_canonical
)
5795 uiout
->field_string ("what", event_location_to_string (b
->location
.get ()));
5796 else if (loc
&& loc
->symtab
)
5798 const struct symbol
*sym
= loc
->symbol
;
5802 uiout
->text ("in ");
5803 uiout
->field_string ("func", sym
->print_name (),
5804 function_name_style
.style ());
5806 uiout
->wrap_hint (wrap_indent_at_field (uiout
, "what"));
5807 uiout
->text ("at ");
5809 uiout
->field_string ("file",
5810 symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc
->symtab
),
5811 file_name_style
.style ());
5814 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
5815 uiout
->field_string ("fullname", symtab_to_fullname (loc
->symtab
));
5817 uiout
->field_signed ("line", loc
->line_number
);
5823 print_address_symbolic (loc
->gdbarch
, loc
->address
, &stb
,
5825 uiout
->field_stream ("at", stb
);
5829 uiout
->field_string ("pending",
5830 event_location_to_string (b
->location
.get ()));
5831 /* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition
5832 or dprintf arguments. In either case, make sure it is printed,
5833 too, but only for non-MI streams. */
5834 if (!uiout
->is_mi_like_p () && b
->extra_string
!= NULL
)
5836 if (b
->type
== bp_dprintf
)
5840 uiout
->text (b
->extra_string
);
5844 if (loc
&& is_breakpoint (b
)
5845 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
5846 && bp_condition_evaluator (b
) == condition_evaluation_both
)
5849 uiout
->field_string ("evaluated-by",
5850 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc
));
5856 bptype_string (enum bptype type
)
5858 struct ep_type_description
5861 const char *description
;
5863 static struct ep_type_description bptypes
[] =
5865 {bp_none
, "?deleted?"},
5866 {bp_breakpoint
, "breakpoint"},
5867 {bp_hardware_breakpoint
, "hw breakpoint"},
5868 {bp_single_step
, "sw single-step"},
5869 {bp_until
, "until"},
5870 {bp_finish
, "finish"},
5871 {bp_watchpoint
, "watchpoint"},
5872 {bp_hardware_watchpoint
, "hw watchpoint"},
5873 {bp_read_watchpoint
, "read watchpoint"},
5874 {bp_access_watchpoint
, "acc watchpoint"},
5875 {bp_longjmp
, "longjmp"},
5876 {bp_longjmp_resume
, "longjmp resume"},
5877 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy
, "longjmp for call dummy"},
5878 {bp_exception
, "exception"},
5879 {bp_exception_resume
, "exception resume"},
5880 {bp_step_resume
, "step resume"},
5881 {bp_hp_step_resume
, "high-priority step resume"},
5882 {bp_watchpoint_scope
, "watchpoint scope"},
5883 {bp_call_dummy
, "call dummy"},
5884 {bp_std_terminate
, "std::terminate"},
5885 {bp_shlib_event
, "shlib events"},
5886 {bp_thread_event
, "thread events"},
5887 {bp_overlay_event
, "overlay events"},
5888 {bp_longjmp_master
, "longjmp master"},
5889 {bp_std_terminate_master
, "std::terminate master"},
5890 {bp_exception_master
, "exception master"},
5891 {bp_catchpoint
, "catchpoint"},
5892 {bp_tracepoint
, "tracepoint"},
5893 {bp_fast_tracepoint
, "fast tracepoint"},
5894 {bp_static_tracepoint
, "static tracepoint"},
5895 {bp_dprintf
, "dprintf"},
5896 {bp_jit_event
, "jit events"},
5897 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver
, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
5898 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return
, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
5901 if (((int) type
>= (sizeof (bptypes
) / sizeof (bptypes
[0])))
5902 || ((int) type
!= bptypes
[(int) type
].type
))
5903 internal_error (__FILE__
, __LINE__
,
5904 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
5907 return bptypes
[(int) type
].description
;
5910 /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
5911 For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
5914 output_thread_groups (struct ui_out
*uiout
,
5915 const char *field_name
,
5916 const std::vector
<int> &inf_nums
,
5919 int is_mi
= uiout
->is_mi_like_p ();
5921 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
5922 there are several. Always display them for MI. */
5923 if (!is_mi
&& mi_only
)
5926 ui_out_emit_list
list_emitter (uiout
, field_name
);
5928 for (size_t i
= 0; i
< inf_nums
.size (); i
++)
5934 xsnprintf (mi_group
, sizeof (mi_group
), "i%d", inf_nums
[i
]);
5935 uiout
->field_string (NULL
, mi_group
);
5940 uiout
->text (" inf ");
5944 uiout
->text (plongest (inf_nums
[i
]));
5949 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. If RAW_LOC, print raw breakpoint locations
5950 instead of going via breakpoint_ops::print_one. This makes "maint
5951 info breakpoints" show the software breakpoint locations of
5952 catchpoints, which are considered internal implementation
5956 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint
*b
,
5957 struct bp_location
*loc
,
5959 struct bp_location
**last_loc
,
5960 int allflag
, bool raw_loc
)
5962 struct command_line
*l
;
5963 static char bpenables
[] = "nynny";
5965 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
5966 int header_of_multiple
= 0;
5967 int part_of_multiple
= (loc
!= NULL
);
5968 struct value_print_options opts
;
5970 get_user_print_options (&opts
);
5972 gdb_assert (!loc
|| loc_number
!= 0);
5973 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
5974 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
5977 && (b
->loc
->next
!= NULL
|| !b
->loc
->enabled
)))
5978 header_of_multiple
= 1;
5986 if (part_of_multiple
)
5987 uiout
->field_fmt ("number", "%d.%d", b
->number
, loc_number
);
5989 uiout
->field_signed ("number", b
->number
);
5993 if (part_of_multiple
)
5994 uiout
->field_skip ("type");
5996 uiout
->field_string ("type", bptype_string (b
->type
));
6000 if (part_of_multiple
)
6001 uiout
->field_skip ("disp");
6003 uiout
->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b
->disposition
));
6007 if (part_of_multiple
)
6008 uiout
->field_string ("enabled", loc
->enabled
? "y" : "n");
6010 uiout
->field_fmt ("enabled", "%c", bpenables
[(int) b
->enable_state
]);
6013 if (!raw_loc
&& b
->ops
!= NULL
&& b
->ops
->print_one
!= NULL
)
6014 b
->ops
->print_one (b
, last_loc
);
6017 if (is_watchpoint (b
))
6019 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) b
;
6021 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6022 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6023 is relatively readable). */
6024 if (opts
.addressprint
)
6025 uiout
->field_skip ("addr");
6027 uiout
->field_string ("what", w
->exp_string
);
6029 else if (!is_catchpoint (b
) || is_exception_catchpoint (b
)
6030 || is_ada_exception_catchpoint (b
))
6032 if (opts
.addressprint
)
6035 if (header_of_multiple
)
6036 uiout
->field_string ("addr", "<MULTIPLE>",
6037 metadata_style
.style ());
6038 else if (b
->loc
== NULL
|| loc
->shlib_disabled
)
6039 uiout
->field_string ("addr", "<PENDING>",
6040 metadata_style
.style ());
6042 uiout
->field_core_addr ("addr",
6043 loc
->gdbarch
, loc
->address
);
6046 if (!header_of_multiple
)
6047 print_breakpoint_location (b
, loc
);
6053 if (loc
!= NULL
&& !header_of_multiple
)
6055 std::vector
<int> inf_nums
;
6058 for (inferior
*inf
: all_inferiors ())
6060 if (inf
->pspace
== loc
->pspace
)
6061 inf_nums
.push_back (inf
->num
);
6064 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6065 there are several. Always display for MI. */
6067 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6068 && (program_spaces
.size () > 1
6069 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
6070 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
6071 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
6072 && loc
->owner
->type
!= bp_catchpoint
))
6074 output_thread_groups (uiout
, "thread-groups", inf_nums
, mi_only
);
6077 if (!part_of_multiple
)
6079 if (b
->thread
!= -1)
6081 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
6082 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
6083 uiout
->text (" thread ");
6084 uiout
->field_signed ("thread", b
->thread
);
6086 else if (b
->task
!= 0)
6088 uiout
->text (" task ");
6089 uiout
->field_signed ("task", b
->task
);
6095 if (!part_of_multiple
)
6096 b
->ops
->print_one_detail (b
, uiout
);
6098 if (part_of_multiple
&& frame_id_p (b
->frame_id
))
6101 uiout
->text ("\tstop only in stack frame at ");
6102 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
6104 uiout
->field_core_addr ("frame",
6105 b
->gdbarch
, b
->frame_id
.stack_addr
);
6109 if (!part_of_multiple
&& b
->cond_string
)
6112 if (is_tracepoint (b
))
6113 uiout
->text ("\ttrace only if ");
6115 uiout
->text ("\tstop only if ");
6116 uiout
->field_string ("cond", b
->cond_string
);
6118 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
6119 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
6120 if (is_breakpoint (b
)
6121 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
6122 == condition_evaluation_target
)
6124 uiout
->message (" (%pF evals)",
6125 string_field ("evaluated-by",
6126 bp_condition_evaluator (b
)));
6131 if (!part_of_multiple
&& b
->thread
!= -1)
6133 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6134 uiout
->text ("\tstop only in thread ");
6135 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
6136 uiout
->field_signed ("thread", b
->thread
);
6139 struct thread_info
*thr
= find_thread_global_id (b
->thread
);
6141 uiout
->field_string ("thread", print_thread_id (thr
));
6146 if (!part_of_multiple
)
6150 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6151 if (is_catchpoint (b
))
6152 uiout
->text ("\tcatchpoint");
6153 else if (is_tracepoint (b
))
6154 uiout
->text ("\ttracepoint");
6156 uiout
->text ("\tbreakpoint");
6157 uiout
->text (" already hit ");
6158 uiout
->field_signed ("times", b
->hit_count
);
6159 if (b
->hit_count
== 1)
6160 uiout
->text (" time\n");
6162 uiout
->text (" times\n");
6166 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
6167 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
6168 uiout
->field_signed ("times", b
->hit_count
);
6172 if (!part_of_multiple
&& b
->ignore_count
)
6175 uiout
->message ("\tignore next %pF hits\n",
6176 signed_field ("ignore", b
->ignore_count
));
6179 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
6180 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
6181 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
6182 if (!part_of_multiple
&& b
->enable_count
> 1)
6185 uiout
->text ("\tdisable after ");
6186 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
6187 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
6188 if (b
->ignore_count
)
6189 uiout
->text ("additional ");
6191 uiout
->text ("next ");
6192 uiout
->field_signed ("enable", b
->enable_count
);
6193 uiout
->text (" hits\n");
6196 if (!part_of_multiple
&& is_tracepoint (b
))
6198 struct tracepoint
*tp
= (struct tracepoint
*) b
;
6200 if (tp
->traceframe_usage
)
6202 uiout
->text ("\ttrace buffer usage ");
6203 uiout
->field_signed ("traceframe-usage", tp
->traceframe_usage
);
6204 uiout
->text (" bytes\n");
6208 l
= b
->commands
? b
->commands
.get () : NULL
;
6209 if (!part_of_multiple
&& l
)
6212 ui_out_emit_tuple
tuple_emitter (uiout
, "script");
6213 print_command_lines (uiout
, l
, 4);
6216 if (is_tracepoint (b
))
6218 struct tracepoint
*t
= (struct tracepoint
*) b
;
6220 if (!part_of_multiple
&& t
->pass_count
)
6222 annotate_field (10);
6223 uiout
->text ("\tpass count ");
6224 uiout
->field_signed ("pass", t
->pass_count
);
6225 uiout
->text (" \n");
6228 /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
6230 if (!header_of_multiple
&& loc
!= NULL
&& !loc
->shlib_disabled
)
6232 annotate_field (11);
6234 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
6235 uiout
->field_string ("installed",
6236 loc
->inserted
? "y" : "n");
6242 uiout
->text ("\tnot ");
6243 uiout
->text ("installed on target\n");
6248 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p () && !part_of_multiple
)
6250 if (is_watchpoint (b
))
6252 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) b
;
6254 uiout
->field_string ("original-location", w
->exp_string
);
6256 else if (b
->location
!= NULL
6257 && event_location_to_string (b
->location
.get ()) != NULL
)
6258 uiout
->field_string ("original-location",
6259 event_location_to_string (b
->location
.get ()));
6263 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6265 bool fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally
= false;
6268 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint
*b
,
6269 struct bp_location
**last_loc
,
6272 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
6273 bool use_fixed_output
6274 = (uiout
->test_flags (fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output
)
6275 || fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally
);
6277 gdb::optional
<ui_out_emit_tuple
> bkpt_tuple_emitter (gdb::in_place
, uiout
, "bkpt");
6278 print_one_breakpoint_location (b
, NULL
, 0, last_loc
, allflag
, false);
6280 /* The mi2 broken format: the main breakpoint tuple ends here, the locations
6282 if (!use_fixed_output
)
6283 bkpt_tuple_emitter
.reset ();
6285 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
6286 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
6287 locations, if any. */
6289 || b
->ops
->print_one
== NULL
6292 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
6293 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
6294 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
6297 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
6298 internally, that's not a property exposed to users.
6300 Likewise, while catchpoints may be implemented with
6301 breakpoints (e.g., catch throw), that's not a property
6302 exposed to users. We do however display the internal
6303 breakpoint locations with "maint info breakpoints". */
6304 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (b
)
6305 && (!is_catchpoint (b
) || is_exception_catchpoint (b
)
6306 || is_ada_exception_catchpoint (b
))
6308 || (b
->loc
&& (b
->loc
->next
|| !b
->loc
->enabled
))))
6310 gdb::optional
<ui_out_emit_list
> locations_list
;
6312 /* For MI version <= 2, keep the behavior where GDB outputs an invalid
6313 MI record. For later versions, place breakpoint locations in a
6315 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p () && use_fixed_output
)
6316 locations_list
.emplace (uiout
, "locations");
6319 for (bp_location
*loc
= b
->loc
; loc
!= NULL
; loc
= loc
->next
, ++n
)
6321 ui_out_emit_tuple
loc_tuple_emitter (uiout
, NULL
);
6322 print_one_breakpoint_location (b
, loc
, n
, last_loc
,
6330 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint
*b
)
6332 int print_address_bits
= 0;
6333 struct bp_location
*loc
;
6335 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have an
6336 address to print. */
6337 if (is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (b
))
6340 for (loc
= b
->loc
; loc
; loc
= loc
->next
)
6344 addr_bit
= gdbarch_addr_bit (loc
->gdbarch
);
6345 if (addr_bit
> print_address_bits
)
6346 print_address_bits
= addr_bit
;
6349 return print_address_bits
;
6352 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6355 print_breakpoint (breakpoint
*b
)
6357 struct bp_location
*dummy_loc
= NULL
;
6358 print_one_breakpoint (b
, &dummy_loc
, 0);
6361 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
6362 internal or momentary. */
6365 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint
*b
)
6367 return b
->number
> 0;
6370 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6373 pending_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint
*b
)
6375 return b
->loc
== NULL
;
6378 /* Print information on breakpoints (including watchpoints and tracepoints).
6380 If non-NULL, BP_NUM_LIST is a list of numbers and number ranges as
6381 understood by number_or_range_parser. Only breakpoints included in this
6382 list are then printed.
6384 If SHOW_INTERNAL is true, print internal breakpoints.
6386 If FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
6387 ones for which it returns true.
6389 Return the total number of breakpoints listed. */
6392 breakpoint_1 (const char *bp_num_list
, bool show_internal
,
6393 bool (*filter
) (const struct breakpoint
*))
6395 struct breakpoint
*b
;
6396 struct bp_location
*last_loc
= NULL
;
6397 int nr_printable_breakpoints
;
6398 struct value_print_options opts
;
6399 int print_address_bits
= 0;
6400 int print_type_col_width
= 14;
6401 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
6403 get_user_print_options (&opts
);
6405 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6406 required for address fields. */
6407 nr_printable_breakpoints
= 0;
6410 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6411 if (filter
&& !filter (b
))
6414 /* If we have a BP_NUM_LIST string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6415 accept. Skip the others. */
6416 if (bp_num_list
!= NULL
&& *bp_num_list
!= '\0')
6418 if (show_internal
&& parse_and_eval_long (bp_num_list
) != b
->number
)
6420 if (!show_internal
&& !number_is_in_list (bp_num_list
, b
->number
))
6424 if (show_internal
|| user_breakpoint_p (b
))
6426 int addr_bit
, type_len
;
6428 addr_bit
= breakpoint_address_bits (b
);
6429 if (addr_bit
> print_address_bits
)
6430 print_address_bits
= addr_bit
;
6432 type_len
= strlen (bptype_string (b
->type
));
6433 if (type_len
> print_type_col_width
)
6434 print_type_col_width
= type_len
;
6436 nr_printable_breakpoints
++;
6441 ui_out_emit_table
table_emitter (uiout
,
6442 opts
.addressprint
? 6 : 5,
6443 nr_printable_breakpoints
,
6446 if (nr_printable_breakpoints
> 0)
6447 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6448 if (nr_printable_breakpoints
> 0)
6450 uiout
->table_header (7, ui_left
, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6451 if (nr_printable_breakpoints
> 0)
6453 uiout
->table_header (print_type_col_width
, ui_left
, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6454 if (nr_printable_breakpoints
> 0)
6456 uiout
->table_header (4, ui_left
, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6457 if (nr_printable_breakpoints
> 0)
6459 uiout
->table_header (3, ui_left
, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6460 if (opts
.addressprint
)
6462 if (nr_printable_breakpoints
> 0)
6464 if (print_address_bits
<= 32)
6465 uiout
->table_header (10, ui_left
, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6467 uiout
->table_header (18, ui_left
, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6469 if (nr_printable_breakpoints
> 0)
6471 uiout
->table_header (40, ui_noalign
, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6472 uiout
->table_body ();
6473 if (nr_printable_breakpoints
> 0)
6474 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6479 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6480 if (filter
&& !filter (b
))
6483 /* If we have a BP_NUM_LIST string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6484 accept. Skip the others. */
6486 if (bp_num_list
!= NULL
&& *bp_num_list
!= '\0')
6488 if (show_internal
) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6490 if (parse_and_eval_long (bp_num_list
) != b
->number
)
6493 else /* all others */
6495 if (!number_is_in_list (bp_num_list
, b
->number
))
6499 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6500 show_internal is set. */
6501 if (show_internal
|| user_breakpoint_p (b
))
6502 print_one_breakpoint (b
, &last_loc
, show_internal
);
6506 if (nr_printable_breakpoints
== 0)
6508 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6512 if (bp_num_list
== NULL
|| *bp_num_list
== '\0')
6513 uiout
->message ("No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6515 uiout
->message ("No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6521 if (last_loc
&& !server_command
)
6522 set_next_address (last_loc
->gdbarch
, last_loc
->address
);
6525 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6526 there have been breakpoints? */
6527 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6529 return nr_printable_breakpoints
;
6532 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6533 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6536 default_collect_info (void)
6538 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
6540 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6541 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6543 if (!*default_collect
)
6546 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6548 uiout
->text ("default collect ");
6549 uiout
->field_string ("default-collect", default_collect
);
6550 uiout
->text (" \n");
6554 info_breakpoints_command (const char *args
, int from_tty
)
6556 breakpoint_1 (args
, false, NULL
);
6558 default_collect_info ();
6562 info_watchpoints_command (const char *args
, int from_tty
)
6564 int num_printed
= breakpoint_1 (args
, false, is_watchpoint
);
6565 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
6567 if (num_printed
== 0)
6569 if (args
== NULL
|| *args
== '\0')
6570 uiout
->message ("No watchpoints.\n");
6572 uiout
->message ("No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args
);
6577 maintenance_info_breakpoints (const char *args
, int from_tty
)
6579 breakpoint_1 (args
, true, NULL
);
6581 default_collect_info ();
6585 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint
*b
,
6586 struct program_space
*pspace
,
6587 CORE_ADDR pc
, struct obj_section
*section
)
6589 struct bp_location
*bl
= b
->loc
;
6591 for (; bl
; bl
= bl
->next
)
6593 if (bl
->pspace
== pspace
6594 && bl
->address
== pc
6595 && (!overlay_debugging
|| bl
->section
== section
))
6601 /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
6602 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
6606 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
6607 struct program_space
*pspace
, CORE_ADDR pc
,
6608 struct obj_section
*section
, int thread
)
6611 struct breakpoint
*b
;
6614 others
+= (user_breakpoint_p (b
)
6615 && breakpoint_has_pc (b
, pspace
, pc
, section
));
6619 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
6620 else /* if (others == ???) */
6621 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
6623 if (user_breakpoint_p (b
) && breakpoint_has_pc (b
, pspace
, pc
, section
))
6626 printf_filtered ("%d", b
->number
);
6627 if (b
->thread
== -1 && thread
!= -1)
6628 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
6629 else if (b
->thread
!= -1)
6630 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b
->thread
);
6631 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
6632 ((b
->enable_state
== bp_disabled
6633 || b
->enable_state
== bp_call_disabled
)
6637 : ((others
== 1) ? " and" : ""));
6639 current_uiout
->message (_("also set at pc %ps.\n"),
6640 styled_string (address_style
.style (),
6641 paddress (gdbarch
, pc
)));
6646 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of LOC.
6647 For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members are
6648 irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to
6649 other addresses (or use them for any other purpose either).
6651 More specifically, software watchpoints and catchpoints that are
6652 not backed by breakpoints always have a zero valued location
6653 address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of these types
6654 to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint location at address
6658 bl_address_is_meaningful (bp_location
*loc
)
6660 return loc
->loc_type
!= bp_loc_other
;
6663 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
6664 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
6667 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location
*loc1
,
6668 struct bp_location
*loc2
)
6670 struct watchpoint
*w1
= (struct watchpoint
*) loc1
->owner
;
6671 struct watchpoint
*w2
= (struct watchpoint
*) loc2
->owner
;
6673 /* Both of them must exist. */
6674 gdb_assert (w1
!= NULL
);
6675 gdb_assert (w2
!= NULL
);
6677 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
6678 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
6679 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
6680 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
6681 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
6682 other watchpoint. */
6684 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1
->address
,
6686 loc1
->watchpoint_type
,
6687 w1
->cond_exp
.get ()))
6689 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2
->address
,
6691 loc2
->watchpoint_type
,
6692 w2
->cond_exp
.get ())))
6695 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
6696 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
6697 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
6698 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
6699 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
6700 become hw_access locations later. */
6701 return (loc1
->owner
->type
== loc2
->owner
->type
6702 && loc1
->pspace
->aspace
== loc2
->pspace
->aspace
6703 && loc1
->address
== loc2
->address
6704 && loc1
->length
== loc2
->length
);
6707 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6710 breakpoint_address_match (const address_space
*aspace1
, CORE_ADDR addr1
,
6711 const address_space
*aspace2
, CORE_ADDR addr2
)
6713 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6714 || aspace1
== aspace2
)
6718 /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
6719 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
6720 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
6721 space doesn't really matter. */
6724 breakpoint_address_match_range (const address_space
*aspace1
,
6726 int len1
, const address_space
*aspace2
,
6729 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6730 || aspace1
== aspace2
)
6731 && addr2
>= addr1
&& addr2
< addr1
+ len1
);
6734 /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
6735 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
6736 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
6737 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
6740 breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location
*bl
,
6741 const address_space
*aspace
,
6744 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl
->pspace
->aspace
, bl
->address
,
6747 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl
->pspace
->aspace
,
6748 bl
->address
, bl
->length
,
6752 /* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps
6753 breakpoint BL. BL may be a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a
6754 match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address
6755 space. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space
6756 doesn't really matter. */
6759 breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location
*bl
,
6760 const address_space
*aspace
,
6761 CORE_ADDR addr
, int len
)
6763 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6764 || bl
->pspace
->aspace
== aspace
)
6766 int bl_len
= bl
->length
!= 0 ? bl
->length
: 1;
6768 if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr
, len
, bl
->address
, bl_len
))
6774 /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
6775 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
6776 true, otherwise returns false. */
6779 tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location
*loc1
,
6780 struct bp_location
*loc2
)
6782 if (is_tracepoint (loc1
->owner
) && is_tracepoint (loc2
->owner
))
6783 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
6784 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
6785 different locations. */
6786 return (loc1
->address
== loc2
->address
&& loc1
->owner
== loc2
->owner
);
6791 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
6792 (bl_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent
6793 the same location. If SW_HW_BPS_MATCH is true, then software
6794 breakpoint locations and hardware breakpoint locations match,
6795 otherwise they don't. */
6798 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location
*loc1
,
6799 struct bp_location
*loc2
,
6800 bool sw_hw_bps_match
)
6802 int hw_point1
, hw_point2
;
6804 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
6805 gdb_assert (loc1
->owner
!= NULL
);
6806 gdb_assert (loc2
->owner
!= NULL
);
6808 hw_point1
= is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1
->owner
);
6809 hw_point2
= is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2
->owner
);
6811 if (hw_point1
!= hw_point2
)
6814 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1
, loc2
);
6815 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1
->owner
) || is_tracepoint (loc2
->owner
))
6816 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1
, loc2
);
6818 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged
6819 breakpoints. Keep this in sync with
6820 bp_location_is_less_than. */
6821 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1
->pspace
->aspace
, loc1
->address
,
6822 loc2
->pspace
->aspace
, loc2
->address
)
6823 && (loc1
->loc_type
== loc2
->loc_type
|| sw_hw_bps_match
)
6824 && loc1
->length
== loc2
->length
);
6828 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr
, CORE_ADDR to_addr
,
6829 int bnum
, int have_bnum
)
6831 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
6832 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
6836 strcpy (astr1
, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr
, 8));
6837 strcpy (astr2
, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr
, 8));
6839 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
6840 bnum
, astr1
, astr2
);
6842 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1
, astr2
);
6845 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
6846 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
6847 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
6848 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
6851 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
6852 CORE_ADDR bpaddr
, enum bptype bptype
)
6854 if (bptype
== bp_watchpoint
6855 || bptype
== bp_hardware_watchpoint
6856 || bptype
== bp_read_watchpoint
6857 || bptype
== bp_access_watchpoint
6858 || bptype
== bp_catchpoint
)
6860 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
6861 have their addresses modified. */
6864 else if (bptype
== bp_single_step
)
6866 /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses
6867 modified. If there's any architectural constrain that
6868 applies to this address, then it should have already been
6869 taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the
6870 first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g.,
6871 Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */
6876 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr
= bpaddr
;
6878 if (gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch
))
6880 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
6881 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
6882 adjusted_bpaddr
= gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch
, bpaddr
);
6885 adjusted_bpaddr
= address_significant (gdbarch
, adjusted_bpaddr
);
6887 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
6888 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
6890 if (adjusted_bpaddr
!= bpaddr
)
6891 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr
, adjusted_bpaddr
, 0, 0);
6893 return adjusted_bpaddr
;
6898 bp_location_from_bp_type (bptype type
)
6903 case bp_single_step
:
6907 case bp_longjmp_resume
:
6908 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy
:
6910 case bp_exception_resume
:
6911 case bp_step_resume
:
6912 case bp_hp_step_resume
:
6913 case bp_watchpoint_scope
:
6915 case bp_std_terminate
:
6916 case bp_shlib_event
:
6917 case bp_thread_event
:
6918 case bp_overlay_event
:
6920 case bp_longjmp_master
:
6921 case bp_std_terminate_master
:
6922 case bp_exception_master
:
6923 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver
:
6924 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return
:
6926 return bp_loc_software_breakpoint
;
6927 case bp_hardware_breakpoint
:
6928 return bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
;
6929 case bp_hardware_watchpoint
:
6930 case bp_read_watchpoint
:
6931 case bp_access_watchpoint
:
6932 return bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
;
6936 case bp_fast_tracepoint
:
6937 case bp_static_tracepoint
:
6938 return bp_loc_other
;
6940 internal_error (__FILE__
, __LINE__
, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
6944 bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint
*owner
, bp_loc_type type
)
6946 this->owner
= owner
;
6947 this->cond_bytecode
= NULL
;
6948 this->shlib_disabled
= 0;
6951 this->loc_type
= type
;
6953 if (this->loc_type
== bp_loc_software_breakpoint
6954 || this->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
)
6955 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (this);
6960 bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint
*owner
)
6961 : bp_location::bp_location (owner
,
6962 bp_location_from_bp_type (owner
->type
))
6966 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
6968 static struct bp_location
*
6969 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint
*bpt
)
6971 return bpt
->ops
->allocate_location (bpt
);
6975 free_bp_location (struct bp_location
*loc
)
6980 /* Increment reference count. */
6983 incref_bp_location (struct bp_location
*bl
)
6988 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
6989 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
6992 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location
**blp
)
6994 gdb_assert ((*blp
)->refc
> 0);
6996 if (--(*blp
)->refc
== 0)
6997 free_bp_location (*blp
);
7001 /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
7004 add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr
<breakpoint
> &&b
)
7006 struct breakpoint
*b1
;
7007 struct breakpoint
*result
= b
.get ();
7009 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
7010 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
7012 b1
= breakpoint_chain
;
7014 breakpoint_chain
= b
.release ();
7019 b1
->next
= b
.release ();
7025 /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
7028 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint
*b
,
7029 struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
7031 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
)
7033 gdb_assert (ops
!= NULL
);
7037 b
->gdbarch
= gdbarch
;
7038 b
->language
= current_language
->la_language
;
7039 b
->input_radix
= input_radix
;
7040 b
->related_breakpoint
= b
;
7043 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
7044 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
7046 static struct breakpoint
*
7047 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
7049 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
)
7051 std::unique_ptr
<breakpoint
> b
= new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype
);
7053 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b
.get (), gdbarch
, bptype
, ops
);
7054 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b
));
7057 /* Initialize loc->function_name. */
7060 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location
*loc
)
7062 gdb_assert (loc
->owner
!= NULL
);
7064 if (loc
->owner
->type
== bp_breakpoint
7065 || loc
->owner
->type
== bp_hardware_breakpoint
7066 || is_tracepoint (loc
->owner
))
7068 const char *function_name
;
7070 if (loc
->msymbol
!= NULL
7071 && (MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc
->msymbol
) == mst_text_gnu_ifunc
7072 || MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc
->msymbol
) == mst_data_gnu_ifunc
))
7074 struct breakpoint
*b
= loc
->owner
;
7076 function_name
= loc
->msymbol
->linkage_name ();
7078 if (b
->type
== bp_breakpoint
&& b
->loc
== loc
7079 && loc
->next
== NULL
&& b
->related_breakpoint
== b
)
7081 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
7082 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
7083 b
->type
= bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver
;
7084 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
7086 loc
->related_address
= loc
->address
;
7090 find_pc_partial_function (loc
->address
, &function_name
, NULL
, NULL
);
7093 loc
->function_name
= xstrdup (function_name
);
7097 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
7099 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal
)
7102 return sal
.section
->objfile
->arch ();
7104 return SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal
.symtab
)->arch ();
7109 /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
7110 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
7111 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
7113 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7114 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7115 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
7118 init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
7119 struct symtab_and_line sal
, enum bptype bptype
,
7120 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
)
7122 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b
, gdbarch
, bptype
, ops
);
7124 add_location_to_breakpoint (b
, &sal
);
7126 if (bptype
!= bp_catchpoint
)
7127 gdb_assert (sal
.pspace
!= NULL
);
7129 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
7130 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
7132 if (bptype
!= bp_breakpoint
&& bptype
!= bp_hardware_breakpoint
)
7133 b
->pspace
= sal
.pspace
;
7136 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
7137 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
7138 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
7139 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
7140 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
7141 is also returned as the value of this function.
7143 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7144 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7145 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
7146 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
7147 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
7148 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
7149 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
7152 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
7153 struct symtab_and_line sal
, enum bptype bptype
,
7154 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
)
7156 std::unique_ptr
<breakpoint
> b
= new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype
);
7158 init_raw_breakpoint (b
.get (), gdbarch
, sal
, bptype
, ops
);
7159 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b
));
7162 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
7163 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
7164 initiated the operation. */
7167 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info
*tp
, struct frame_id frame
)
7169 struct breakpoint
*b
, *b_tmp
;
7170 int thread
= tp
->global_num
;
7172 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
7173 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
7174 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
7175 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
7176 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, b_tmp
)
7177 if (b
->pspace
== current_program_space
7178 && (b
->type
== bp_longjmp_master
7179 || b
->type
== bp_exception_master
))
7181 enum bptype type
= b
->type
== bp_longjmp_master
? bp_longjmp
: bp_exception
;
7182 struct breakpoint
*clone
;
7184 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
7185 after their removal. */
7186 clone
= momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b
, type
,
7187 &momentary_breakpoint_ops
, 1);
7188 clone
->thread
= thread
;
7191 tp
->initiating_frame
= frame
;
7194 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
7196 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread
)
7198 struct breakpoint
*b
, *b_tmp
;
7200 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, b_tmp
)
7201 if (b
->type
== bp_longjmp
|| b
->type
== bp_exception
)
7203 if (b
->thread
== thread
)
7204 delete_breakpoint (b
);
7209 delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread
)
7211 struct breakpoint
*b
, *b_tmp
;
7213 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, b_tmp
)
7214 if (b
->type
== bp_longjmp
|| b
->type
== bp_exception
)
7216 if (b
->thread
== thread
)
7217 b
->disposition
= disp_del_at_next_stop
;
7221 /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
7222 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
7223 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
7227 set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
7229 struct breakpoint
*b
, *retval
= NULL
;
7232 if (b
->pspace
== current_program_space
&& b
->type
== bp_longjmp_master
)
7234 struct breakpoint
*new_b
;
7236 new_b
= momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b
, bp_longjmp_call_dummy
,
7237 &momentary_breakpoint_ops
,
7239 new_b
->thread
= inferior_thread ()->global_num
;
7241 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
7243 gdb_assert (new_b
->related_breakpoint
== new_b
);
7246 new_b
->related_breakpoint
= retval
;
7247 while (retval
->related_breakpoint
!= new_b
->related_breakpoint
)
7248 retval
= retval
->related_breakpoint
;
7249 retval
->related_breakpoint
= new_b
;
7255 /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
7256 TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
7259 You should call this function only at places where it is safe to currently
7260 unwind the whole stack. Failed stack unwind would discard live dummy
7264 check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info
*tp
)
7266 struct breakpoint
*b
, *b_tmp
;
7268 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, b_tmp
)
7269 if (b
->type
== bp_longjmp_call_dummy
&& b
->thread
== tp
->global_num
)
7271 struct breakpoint
*dummy_b
= b
->related_breakpoint
;
7273 while (dummy_b
!= b
&& dummy_b
->type
!= bp_call_dummy
)
7274 dummy_b
= dummy_b
->related_breakpoint
;
7275 if (dummy_b
->type
!= bp_call_dummy
7276 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b
->frame_id
) != NULL
)
7279 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b
->frame_id
, tp
);
7281 while (b
->related_breakpoint
!= b
)
7283 if (b_tmp
== b
->related_breakpoint
)
7284 b_tmp
= b
->related_breakpoint
->next
;
7285 delete_breakpoint (b
->related_breakpoint
);
7287 delete_breakpoint (b
);
7292 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7294 struct breakpoint
*b
;
7297 if (b
->type
== bp_overlay_event
)
7299 b
->enable_state
= bp_enabled
;
7300 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT
);
7301 overlay_events_enabled
= 1;
7306 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7308 struct breakpoint
*b
;
7311 if (b
->type
== bp_overlay_event
)
7313 b
->enable_state
= bp_disabled
;
7314 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT
);
7315 overlay_events_enabled
= 0;
7319 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
7320 master breakpoint. */
7322 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7324 struct breakpoint
*b
, *b_tmp
;
7326 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, b_tmp
)
7327 if (b
->pspace
== current_program_space
7328 && b
->type
== bp_std_terminate_master
)
7330 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b
, bp_std_terminate
,
7331 &momentary_breakpoint_ops
, 1);
7335 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
7337 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7339 struct breakpoint
*b
, *b_tmp
;
7341 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, b_tmp
)
7342 if (b
->type
== bp_std_terminate
)
7343 delete_breakpoint (b
);
7347 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
, CORE_ADDR address
)
7349 struct breakpoint
*b
;
7351 b
= create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch
, address
, bp_thread_event
,
7352 &internal_breakpoint_ops
);
7354 b
->enable_state
= bp_enabled
;
7355 /* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
7356 b
->location
= new_address_location (b
->loc
->address
, NULL
, 0);
7358 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT
);
7363 struct lang_and_radix
7369 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7372 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
, CORE_ADDR address
)
7374 return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch
, address
, bp_jit_event
,
7375 &internal_breakpoint_ops
);
7378 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7381 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7383 struct breakpoint
*b
, *b_tmp
;
7385 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, b_tmp
)
7386 if (b
->type
== bp_jit_event
7387 && b
->loc
->pspace
== current_program_space
)
7388 delete_breakpoint (b
);
7392 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7394 struct breakpoint
*b
, *b_tmp
;
7396 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, b_tmp
)
7397 if (b
->type
== bp_shlib_event
7398 && b
->loc
->pspace
== current_program_space
)
7399 delete_breakpoint (b
);
7402 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7405 remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void)
7407 struct breakpoint
*b
, *b_tmp
;
7409 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, b_tmp
)
7410 if (b
->type
== bp_shlib_event
7411 && b
->loc
->pspace
== current_program_space
)
7412 b
->disposition
= disp_del_at_next_stop
;
7415 /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint /
7416 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which
7417 INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */
7419 static struct breakpoint
*
7420 create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
, CORE_ADDR address
,
7421 enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode
)
7423 struct breakpoint
*b
;
7425 b
= create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch
, address
, bp_shlib_event
,
7426 &internal_breakpoint_ops
);
7427 update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode
);
7432 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
, CORE_ADDR address
)
7434 return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch
, address
, UGLL_MAY_INSERT
);
7437 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7440 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
, CORE_ADDR address
)
7442 struct breakpoint
*b
;
7444 /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert
7446 b
= create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch
, address
, UGLL_INSERT
);
7447 if (!b
->loc
->inserted
)
7449 delete_breakpoint (b
);
7455 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7456 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7459 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7461 struct bp_location
*loc
, **locp_tmp
;
7463 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc
, locp_tmp
)
7465 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7466 struct breakpoint
*b
= loc
->owner
;
7468 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7469 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7470 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7471 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7472 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7473 if (((b
->type
== bp_breakpoint
)
7474 || (b
->type
== bp_jit_event
)
7475 || (b
->type
== bp_hardware_breakpoint
)
7476 || (is_tracepoint (b
)))
7477 && loc
->pspace
== current_program_space
7478 && !loc
->shlib_disabled
7479 && solib_name_from_address (loc
->pspace
, loc
->address
)
7482 loc
->shlib_disabled
= 1;
7487 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
7488 notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7489 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7492 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list
*solib
)
7494 struct bp_location
*loc
, **locp_tmp
;
7495 int disabled_shlib_breaks
= 0;
7497 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc
, locp_tmp
)
7499 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7500 struct breakpoint
*b
= loc
->owner
;
7502 if (solib
->pspace
== loc
->pspace
7503 && !loc
->shlib_disabled
7504 && (((b
->type
== bp_breakpoint
7505 || b
->type
== bp_jit_event
7506 || b
->type
== bp_hardware_breakpoint
)
7507 && (loc
->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7508 || loc
->loc_type
== bp_loc_software_breakpoint
))
7509 || is_tracepoint (b
))
7510 && solib_contains_address_p (solib
, loc
->address
))
7512 loc
->shlib_disabled
= 1;
7513 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7514 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7515 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7518 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7519 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified
.notify (b
);
7521 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks
)
7523 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
7524 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
7525 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
7528 disabled_shlib_breaks
= 1;
7533 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
7534 notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7535 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7538 disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile
*objfile
)
7540 struct breakpoint
*b
;
7542 if (objfile
== NULL
)
7545 /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
7546 managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
7547 Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
7548 response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
7549 shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
7550 location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
7551 aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
7552 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
7553 solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
7554 OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
7556 if ((objfile
->flags
& OBJF_SHARED
) == 0
7557 || (objfile
->flags
& OBJF_USERLOADED
) == 0)
7562 struct bp_location
*loc
;
7563 int bp_modified
= 0;
7565 if (!is_breakpoint (b
) && !is_tracepoint (b
))
7568 for (loc
= b
->loc
; loc
!= NULL
; loc
= loc
->next
)
7570 CORE_ADDR loc_addr
= loc
->address
;
7572 if (loc
->loc_type
!= bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7573 && loc
->loc_type
!= bp_loc_software_breakpoint
)
7576 if (loc
->shlib_disabled
!= 0)
7579 if (objfile
->pspace
!= loc
->pspace
)
7582 if (loc
->loc_type
!= bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7583 && loc
->loc_type
!= bp_loc_software_breakpoint
)
7586 if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr
, objfile
))
7588 loc
->shlib_disabled
= 1;
7589 /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
7590 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
7591 inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
7592 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
7595 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc
);
7602 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified
.notify (b
);
7606 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
7608 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
7609 catchpoint. A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points
7610 to CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7612 struct fork_catchpoint
: public breakpoint
7614 /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
7615 catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
7616 catchpoint has triggered. */
7617 ptid_t forked_inferior_pid
;
7620 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7624 insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location
*bl
)
7626 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid
.pid ());
7629 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7633 remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location
*bl
, enum remove_bp_reason reason
)
7635 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid
.pid ());
7638 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7642 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location
*bl
,
7643 const address_space
*aspace
, CORE_ADDR bp_addr
,
7644 const struct target_waitstatus
*ws
)
7646 struct fork_catchpoint
*c
= (struct fork_catchpoint
*) bl
->owner
;
7648 if (ws
->kind
!= TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED
)
7651 c
->forked_inferior_pid
= ws
->value
.related_pid
;
7655 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7658 static enum print_stop_action
7659 print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs
)
7661 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
7662 struct breakpoint
*b
= bs
->breakpoint_at
;
7663 struct fork_catchpoint
*c
= (struct fork_catchpoint
*) bs
->breakpoint_at
;
7665 annotate_catchpoint (b
->number
);
7666 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout
);
7667 if (b
->disposition
== disp_del
)
7668 uiout
->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7670 uiout
->text ("Catchpoint ");
7671 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
7673 uiout
->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK
));
7674 uiout
->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b
->disposition
));
7676 uiout
->field_signed ("bkptno", b
->number
);
7677 uiout
->text (" (forked process ");
7678 uiout
->field_signed ("newpid", c
->forked_inferior_pid
.pid ());
7679 uiout
->text ("), ");
7680 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
;
7683 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7687 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct bp_location
**last_loc
)
7689 struct fork_catchpoint
*c
= (struct fork_catchpoint
*) b
;
7690 struct value_print_options opts
;
7691 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
7693 get_user_print_options (&opts
);
7695 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7696 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7698 if (opts
.addressprint
)
7699 uiout
->field_skip ("addr");
7701 uiout
->text ("fork");
7702 if (c
->forked_inferior_pid
!= null_ptid
)
7704 uiout
->text (", process ");
7705 uiout
->field_signed ("what", c
->forked_inferior_pid
.pid ());
7709 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
7710 uiout
->field_string ("catch-type", "fork");
7713 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7717 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint
*b
)
7719 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b
->number
);
7722 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7726 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct ui_file
*fp
)
7728 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "catch fork");
7729 print_recreate_thread (b
, fp
);
7732 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
7734 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops
;
7736 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7740 insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location
*bl
)
7742 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid
.pid ());
7745 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7749 remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location
*bl
, enum remove_bp_reason reason
)
7751 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid
.pid ());
7754 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7758 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location
*bl
,
7759 const address_space
*aspace
, CORE_ADDR bp_addr
,
7760 const struct target_waitstatus
*ws
)
7762 struct fork_catchpoint
*c
= (struct fork_catchpoint
*) bl
->owner
;
7764 if (ws
->kind
!= TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED
)
7767 c
->forked_inferior_pid
= ws
->value
.related_pid
;
7771 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7774 static enum print_stop_action
7775 print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs
)
7777 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
7778 struct breakpoint
*b
= bs
->breakpoint_at
;
7779 struct fork_catchpoint
*c
= (struct fork_catchpoint
*) b
;
7781 annotate_catchpoint (b
->number
);
7782 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout
);
7783 if (b
->disposition
== disp_del
)
7784 uiout
->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7786 uiout
->text ("Catchpoint ");
7787 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
7789 uiout
->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK
));
7790 uiout
->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b
->disposition
));
7792 uiout
->field_signed ("bkptno", b
->number
);
7793 uiout
->text (" (vforked process ");
7794 uiout
->field_signed ("newpid", c
->forked_inferior_pid
.pid ());
7795 uiout
->text ("), ");
7796 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
;
7799 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7803 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct bp_location
**last_loc
)
7805 struct fork_catchpoint
*c
= (struct fork_catchpoint
*) b
;
7806 struct value_print_options opts
;
7807 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
7809 get_user_print_options (&opts
);
7810 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7811 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7813 if (opts
.addressprint
)
7814 uiout
->field_skip ("addr");
7816 uiout
->text ("vfork");
7817 if (c
->forked_inferior_pid
!= null_ptid
)
7819 uiout
->text (", process ");
7820 uiout
->field_signed ("what", c
->forked_inferior_pid
.pid ());
7824 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
7825 uiout
->field_string ("catch-type", "vfork");
7828 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7832 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint
*b
)
7834 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b
->number
);
7837 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7841 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct ui_file
*fp
)
7843 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "catch vfork");
7844 print_recreate_thread (b
, fp
);
7847 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
7849 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops
;
7851 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
7852 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
7853 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7855 struct solib_catchpoint
: public breakpoint
7857 ~solib_catchpoint () override
;
7859 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
7860 unsigned char is_load
;
7862 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
7863 REGEX is non-NULL. */
7865 std::unique_ptr
<compiled_regex
> compiled
;
7868 solib_catchpoint::~solib_catchpoint ()
7870 xfree (this->regex
);
7874 insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location
*ignore
)
7880 remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location
*ignore
, enum remove_bp_reason reason
)
7886 breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location
*bl
,
7887 const address_space
*aspace
,
7889 const struct target_waitstatus
*ws
)
7891 struct solib_catchpoint
*self
= (struct solib_catchpoint
*) bl
->owner
;
7892 struct breakpoint
*other
;
7894 if (ws
->kind
== TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED
)
7897 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other
)
7899 struct bp_location
*other_bl
;
7901 if (other
== bl
->owner
)
7904 if (other
->type
!= bp_shlib_event
)
7907 if (self
->pspace
!= NULL
&& other
->pspace
!= self
->pspace
)
7910 for (other_bl
= other
->loc
; other_bl
!= NULL
; other_bl
= other_bl
->next
)
7912 if (other
->ops
->breakpoint_hit (other_bl
, aspace
, bp_addr
, ws
))
7921 check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats
*bs
)
7923 struct solib_catchpoint
*self
7924 = (struct solib_catchpoint
*) bs
->breakpoint_at
;
7928 for (so_list
*iter
: current_program_space
->added_solibs
)
7931 || self
->compiled
->exec (iter
->so_name
, 0, NULL
, 0) == 0)
7937 for (const std::string
&iter
: current_program_space
->deleted_solibs
)
7940 || self
->compiled
->exec (iter
.c_str (), 0, NULL
, 0) == 0)
7946 bs
->print_it
= print_it_noop
;
7949 static enum print_stop_action
7950 print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs
)
7952 struct breakpoint
*b
= bs
->breakpoint_at
;
7953 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
7955 annotate_catchpoint (b
->number
);
7956 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout
);
7957 if (b
->disposition
== disp_del
)
7958 uiout
->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7960 uiout
->text ("Catchpoint ");
7961 uiout
->field_signed ("bkptno", b
->number
);
7963 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
7964 uiout
->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b
->disposition
));
7965 print_solib_event (1);
7966 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
;
7970 print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct bp_location
**locs
)
7972 struct solib_catchpoint
*self
= (struct solib_catchpoint
*) b
;
7973 struct value_print_options opts
;
7974 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
7976 get_user_print_options (&opts
);
7977 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7978 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7980 if (opts
.addressprint
)
7983 uiout
->field_skip ("addr");
7991 msg
= string_printf (_("load of library matching %s"), self
->regex
);
7993 msg
= _("load of library");
7998 msg
= string_printf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self
->regex
);
8000 msg
= _("unload of library");
8002 uiout
->field_string ("what", msg
);
8004 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
8005 uiout
->field_string ("catch-type", self
->is_load
? "load" : "unload");
8009 print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint
*b
)
8011 struct solib_catchpoint
*self
= (struct solib_catchpoint
*) b
;
8013 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b
->number
,
8014 self
->is_load
? "load" : "unload");
8018 print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct ui_file
*fp
)
8020 struct solib_catchpoint
*self
= (struct solib_catchpoint
*) b
;
8022 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "%s %s",
8023 b
->disposition
== disp_del
? "tcatch" : "catch",
8024 self
->is_load
? "load" : "unload");
8026 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, " %s", self
->regex
);
8027 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "\n");
8030 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops
;
8032 /* Shared helper function (MI and CLI) for creating and installing
8033 a shared object event catchpoint. If IS_LOAD is non-zero then
8034 the events to be caught are load events, otherwise they are
8035 unload events. If IS_TEMP is non-zero the catchpoint is a
8036 temporary one. If ENABLED is non-zero the catchpoint is
8037 created in an enabled state. */
8040 add_solib_catchpoint (const char *arg
, int is_load
, int is_temp
, int enabled
)
8042 struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
= get_current_arch ();
8046 arg
= skip_spaces (arg
);
8048 std::unique_ptr
<solib_catchpoint
> c (new solib_catchpoint ());
8052 c
->compiled
.reset (new compiled_regex (arg
, REG_NOSUB
,
8053 _("Invalid regexp")));
8054 c
->regex
= xstrdup (arg
);
8057 c
->is_load
= is_load
;
8058 init_catchpoint (c
.get (), gdbarch
, is_temp
, NULL
,
8059 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops
);
8061 c
->enable_state
= enabled
? bp_enabled
: bp_disabled
;
8063 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c
), 1);
8066 /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
8070 catch_load_or_unload (const char *arg
, int from_tty
, int is_load
,
8071 struct cmd_list_element
*command
)
8074 const int enabled
= 1;
8076 tempflag
= get_cmd_context (command
) == CATCH_TEMPORARY
;
8078 add_solib_catchpoint (arg
, is_load
, tempflag
, enabled
);
8082 catch_load_command_1 (const char *arg
, int from_tty
,
8083 struct cmd_list_element
*command
)
8085 catch_load_or_unload (arg
, from_tty
, 1, command
);
8089 catch_unload_command_1 (const char *arg
, int from_tty
,
8090 struct cmd_list_element
*command
)
8092 catch_load_or_unload (arg
, from_tty
, 0, command
);
8095 /* Initialize a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind. If TEMPFLAG
8096 is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary. If COND_STRING is
8097 not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint. OPS, if not NULL, is
8098 the breakpoint_ops structure associated to the catchpoint. */
8101 init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint
*b
,
8102 struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
, int tempflag
,
8103 const char *cond_string
,
8104 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
)
8106 symtab_and_line sal
;
8107 sal
.pspace
= current_program_space
;
8109 init_raw_breakpoint (b
, gdbarch
, sal
, bp_catchpoint
, ops
);
8111 b
->cond_string
= (cond_string
== NULL
) ? NULL
: xstrdup (cond_string
);
8112 b
->disposition
= tempflag
? disp_del
: disp_donttouch
;
8116 install_breakpoint (int internal
, std::unique_ptr
<breakpoint
> &&arg
, int update_gll
)
8118 breakpoint
*b
= add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (arg
));
8119 set_breakpoint_number (internal
, b
);
8120 if (is_tracepoint (b
))
8121 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count
);
8124 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created
.notify (b
);
8127 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT
);
8131 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
8132 int tempflag
, const char *cond_string
,
8133 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
)
8135 std::unique_ptr
<fork_catchpoint
> c (new fork_catchpoint ());
8137 init_catchpoint (c
.get (), gdbarch
, tempflag
, cond_string
, ops
);
8139 c
->forked_inferior_pid
= null_ptid
;
8141 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c
), 1);
8144 /* Exec catchpoints. */
8146 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
8147 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8148 CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8150 struct exec_catchpoint
: public breakpoint
8152 ~exec_catchpoint () override
;
8154 /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
8155 This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
8157 char *exec_pathname
;
8160 /* Exec catchpoint destructor. */
8162 exec_catchpoint::~exec_catchpoint ()
8164 xfree (this->exec_pathname
);
8168 insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location
*bl
)
8170 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid
.pid ());
8174 remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location
*bl
, enum remove_bp_reason reason
)
8176 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid
.pid ());
8180 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location
*bl
,
8181 const address_space
*aspace
, CORE_ADDR bp_addr
,
8182 const struct target_waitstatus
*ws
)
8184 struct exec_catchpoint
*c
= (struct exec_catchpoint
*) bl
->owner
;
8186 if (ws
->kind
!= TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD
)
8189 c
->exec_pathname
= xstrdup (ws
->value
.execd_pathname
);
8193 static enum print_stop_action
8194 print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs
)
8196 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
8197 struct breakpoint
*b
= bs
->breakpoint_at
;
8198 struct exec_catchpoint
*c
= (struct exec_catchpoint
*) b
;
8200 annotate_catchpoint (b
->number
);
8201 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout
);
8202 if (b
->disposition
== disp_del
)
8203 uiout
->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8205 uiout
->text ("Catchpoint ");
8206 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
8208 uiout
->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC
));
8209 uiout
->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b
->disposition
));
8211 uiout
->field_signed ("bkptno", b
->number
);
8212 uiout
->text (" (exec'd ");
8213 uiout
->field_string ("new-exec", c
->exec_pathname
);
8214 uiout
->text ("), ");
8216 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
;
8220 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct bp_location
**last_loc
)
8222 struct exec_catchpoint
*c
= (struct exec_catchpoint
*) b
;
8223 struct value_print_options opts
;
8224 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
8226 get_user_print_options (&opts
);
8228 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
8229 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
8230 is relatively readable). */
8231 if (opts
.addressprint
)
8232 uiout
->field_skip ("addr");
8234 uiout
->text ("exec");
8235 if (c
->exec_pathname
!= NULL
)
8237 uiout
->text (", program \"");
8238 uiout
->field_string ("what", c
->exec_pathname
);
8239 uiout
->text ("\" ");
8242 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
8243 uiout
->field_string ("catch-type", "exec");
8247 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint
*b
)
8249 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b
->number
);
8252 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8256 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct ui_file
*fp
)
8258 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "catch exec");
8259 print_recreate_thread (b
, fp
);
8262 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops
;
8265 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
8268 struct breakpoint
*b
;
8269 struct bp_location
*bl
;
8273 if (b
->type
== bp_hardware_breakpoint
&& breakpoint_enabled (b
))
8274 for (bl
= b
->loc
; bl
; bl
= bl
->next
)
8276 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8278 i
+= b
->ops
->resources_needed (bl
);
8285 /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
8289 hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint
*b
)
8292 struct bp_location
*bl
;
8294 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b
))
8297 for (bl
= b
->loc
; bl
; bl
= bl
->next
)
8299 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
8301 i
+= b
->ops
->resources_needed (bl
);
8307 /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
8308 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
8309 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
8310 types _not_ TYPE. */
8313 hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint
*except
,
8314 enum bptype type
, int *other_type_used
)
8317 struct breakpoint
*b
;
8319 *other_type_used
= 0;
8324 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b
))
8327 if (b
->type
== type
)
8328 i
+= hw_watchpoint_use_count (b
);
8329 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b
))
8330 *other_type_used
= 1;
8337 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
8339 struct breakpoint
*b
;
8343 if (is_watchpoint (b
) && breakpoint_enabled (b
))
8345 b
->enable_state
= bp_call_disabled
;
8346 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT
);
8352 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
8354 struct breakpoint
*b
;
8358 if (is_watchpoint (b
) && b
->enable_state
== bp_call_disabled
)
8360 b
->enable_state
= bp_enabled
;
8361 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT
);
8367 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
8369 current_program_space
->executing_startup
= 1;
8370 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT
);
8374 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
8376 current_program_space
->executing_startup
= 0;
8377 breakpoint_re_set ();
8380 /* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no
8383 static struct breakpoint
*
8384 new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread
, struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
)
8386 std::unique_ptr
<breakpoint
> b (new breakpoint ());
8388 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b
.get (), gdbarch
, bp_single_step
,
8389 &momentary_breakpoint_ops
);
8391 b
->disposition
= disp_donttouch
;
8392 b
->frame_id
= null_frame_id
;
8395 gdb_assert (b
->thread
!= 0);
8397 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b
));
8400 /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by
8401 SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that
8405 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
, struct symtab_and_line sal
,
8406 struct frame_id frame_id
, enum bptype type
)
8408 struct breakpoint
*b
;
8410 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
8412 gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id
));
8414 b
= set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch
, sal
, type
, &momentary_breakpoint_ops
);
8415 b
->enable_state
= bp_enabled
;
8416 b
->disposition
= disp_donttouch
;
8417 b
->frame_id
= frame_id
;
8419 b
->thread
= inferior_thread ()->global_num
;
8421 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT
);
8423 return breakpoint_up (b
);
8426 /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
8427 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
8428 breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
8430 static struct breakpoint
*
8431 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint
*orig
,
8433 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
,
8436 struct breakpoint
*copy
;
8438 copy
= set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig
->gdbarch
, type
, ops
);
8439 copy
->loc
= allocate_bp_location (copy
);
8440 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy
->loc
);
8442 copy
->loc
->gdbarch
= orig
->loc
->gdbarch
;
8443 copy
->loc
->requested_address
= orig
->loc
->requested_address
;
8444 copy
->loc
->address
= orig
->loc
->address
;
8445 copy
->loc
->section
= orig
->loc
->section
;
8446 copy
->loc
->pspace
= orig
->loc
->pspace
;
8447 copy
->loc
->probe
= orig
->loc
->probe
;
8448 copy
->loc
->line_number
= orig
->loc
->line_number
;
8449 copy
->loc
->symtab
= orig
->loc
->symtab
;
8450 copy
->loc
->enabled
= loc_enabled
;
8451 copy
->frame_id
= orig
->frame_id
;
8452 copy
->thread
= orig
->thread
;
8453 copy
->pspace
= orig
->pspace
;
8455 copy
->enable_state
= bp_enabled
;
8456 copy
->disposition
= disp_donttouch
;
8457 copy
->number
= internal_breakpoint_number
--;
8459 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT
);
8463 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
8467 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint
*orig
)
8469 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
8473 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig
, orig
->type
, orig
->ops
, 0);
8477 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
, CORE_ADDR pc
,
8480 struct symtab_and_line sal
;
8482 sal
= find_pc_line (pc
, 0);
8484 sal
.section
= find_pc_overlay (pc
);
8485 sal
.explicit_pc
= 1;
8487 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch
, sal
, null_frame_id
, type
);
8491 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
8494 mention (struct breakpoint
*b
)
8496 b
->ops
->print_mention (b
);
8497 current_uiout
->text ("\n");
8501 static bool bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location
*loc
);
8503 /* Handle "set breakpoint auto-hw on".
8505 If the explicitly specified breakpoint type is not hardware
8506 breakpoint, check the memory map to see whether the breakpoint
8507 address is in read-only memory.
8509 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory is read-only.
8510 We change the type of the location to hardware breakpoint.
8512 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write. This
8513 means we've previously made the location hardware one, but then the
8514 memory map changed, so we undo.
8518 handle_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (bp_location
*bl
)
8520 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints
8521 && bl
->owner
->type
!= bp_hardware_breakpoint
8522 && (bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_software_breakpoint
8523 || bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
))
8525 /* When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
8526 location types we've just set here, the only possible problem
8527 is that memory map has changed during running program, but
8528 it's not going to work anyway with current gdb. */
8529 mem_region
*mr
= lookup_mem_region (bl
->address
);
8533 enum bp_loc_type new_type
;
8535 if (mr
->attrib
.mode
!= MEM_RW
)
8536 new_type
= bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
;
8538 new_type
= bp_loc_software_breakpoint
;
8540 if (new_type
!= bl
->loc_type
)
8542 static bool said
= false;
8544 bl
->loc_type
= new_type
;
8547 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout
,
8548 _("Note: automatically using "
8549 "hardware breakpoints for "
8550 "read-only addresses.\n"));
8558 static struct bp_location
*
8559 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint
*b
,
8560 const struct symtab_and_line
*sal
)
8562 struct bp_location
*loc
, **tmp
;
8563 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address
;
8564 struct gdbarch
*loc_gdbarch
= get_sal_arch (*sal
);
8566 if (loc_gdbarch
== NULL
)
8567 loc_gdbarch
= b
->gdbarch
;
8569 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
8570 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
8571 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
8572 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
8573 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
8574 location that's only been partially initialized. */
8575 adjusted_address
= adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch
,
8578 /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
8579 loc
= allocate_bp_location (b
);
8580 for (tmp
= &(b
->loc
); *tmp
!= NULL
&& (*tmp
)->address
<= adjusted_address
;
8581 tmp
= &((*tmp
)->next
))
8586 loc
->requested_address
= sal
->pc
;
8587 loc
->address
= adjusted_address
;
8588 loc
->pspace
= sal
->pspace
;
8589 loc
->probe
.prob
= sal
->prob
;
8590 loc
->probe
.objfile
= sal
->objfile
;
8591 gdb_assert (loc
->pspace
!= NULL
);
8592 loc
->section
= sal
->section
;
8593 loc
->gdbarch
= loc_gdbarch
;
8594 loc
->line_number
= sal
->line
;
8595 loc
->symtab
= sal
->symtab
;
8596 loc
->symbol
= sal
->symbol
;
8597 loc
->msymbol
= sal
->msymbol
;
8598 loc
->objfile
= sal
->objfile
;
8600 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc
);
8602 /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
8603 code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect
8604 that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program,
8605 thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing
8606 the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a
8607 SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the
8608 instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies
8609 with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the
8610 breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB
8611 breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed.
8612 (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint,
8613 it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint
8615 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc
))
8622 /* Return true if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
8623 return false otherwise. */
8626 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location
*loc
)
8628 gdb_assert (loc
!= NULL
);
8630 /* If we have a non-breakpoint-backed catchpoint or a software
8631 watchpoint, just return 0. We should not attempt to read from
8632 the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types point to.
8633 gdbarch_program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read
8635 if (!bl_address_is_meaningful (loc
))
8638 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread
;
8639 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc
->pspace
);
8640 return gdbarch_program_breakpoint_here_p (loc
->gdbarch
, loc
->address
);
8643 /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
8644 settings of the dprintf style options. */
8647 update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint
*b
)
8649 char *dprintf_args
= b
->extra_string
;
8650 char *printf_line
= NULL
;
8655 dprintf_args
= skip_spaces (dprintf_args
);
8657 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
8659 if (*dprintf_args
== ',')
8661 dprintf_args
= skip_spaces (dprintf_args
);
8663 if (*dprintf_args
!= '"')
8664 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
8666 if (strcmp (dprintf_style
, dprintf_style_gdb
) == 0)
8667 printf_line
= xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args
);
8668 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style
, dprintf_style_call
) == 0)
8670 if (!dprintf_function
)
8671 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
8673 if (dprintf_channel
&& strlen (dprintf_channel
) > 0)
8674 printf_line
= xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
8679 printf_line
= xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
8683 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style
, dprintf_style_agent
) == 0)
8685 if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
8686 printf_line
= xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args
);
8689 warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
8690 printf_line
= xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args
);
8694 internal_error (__FILE__
, __LINE__
,
8695 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
8697 gdb_assert (printf_line
!= NULL
);
8699 /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
8700 struct command_line
*printf_cmd_line
8701 = new struct command_line (simple_control
, printf_line
);
8702 breakpoint_set_commands (b
, counted_command_line (printf_cmd_line
,
8703 command_lines_deleter ()));
8706 /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
8707 current style settings. */
8710 update_dprintf_commands (const char *args
, int from_tty
,
8711 struct cmd_list_element
*c
)
8713 struct breakpoint
*b
;
8717 if (b
->type
== bp_dprintf
)
8718 update_dprintf_command_list (b
);
8722 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use LOCATION
8723 as a description of the location, and COND_STRING
8724 as condition expression. If LOCATION is NULL then create an
8725 "address location" from the address in the SAL. */
8728 init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
8729 gdb::array_view
<const symtab_and_line
> sals
,
8730 event_location_up
&&location
,
8731 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> filter
,
8732 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> cond_string
,
8733 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> extra_string
,
8734 enum bptype type
, enum bpdisp disposition
,
8735 int thread
, int task
, int ignore_count
,
8736 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
, int from_tty
,
8737 int enabled
, int internal
, unsigned flags
,
8738 int display_canonical
)
8742 if (type
== bp_hardware_breakpoint
)
8744 int target_resources_ok
;
8746 i
= hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
8747 target_resources_ok
=
8748 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint
,
8750 if (target_resources_ok
== 0)
8751 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
8752 else if (target_resources_ok
< 0)
8753 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
8756 gdb_assert (!sals
.empty ());
8758 for (const auto &sal
: sals
)
8760 struct bp_location
*loc
;
8764 struct gdbarch
*loc_gdbarch
= get_sal_arch (sal
);
8766 loc_gdbarch
= gdbarch
;
8768 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch
,
8769 sal
.pspace
, sal
.pc
, sal
.section
, thread
);
8772 if (&sal
== &sals
[0])
8774 init_raw_breakpoint (b
, gdbarch
, sal
, type
, ops
);
8778 b
->cond_string
= cond_string
.release ();
8779 b
->extra_string
= extra_string
.release ();
8780 b
->ignore_count
= ignore_count
;
8781 b
->enable_state
= enabled
? bp_enabled
: bp_disabled
;
8782 b
->disposition
= disposition
;
8784 if ((flags
& CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED
) != 0)
8785 b
->loc
->inserted
= 1;
8787 if (type
== bp_static_tracepoint
)
8789 struct tracepoint
*t
= (struct tracepoint
*) b
;
8790 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker
;
8792 if (strace_marker_p (b
))
8794 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
8795 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
8797 = &event_location_to_string (b
->location
.get ())[3];
8800 p
= skip_spaces (p
);
8802 endp
= skip_to_space (p
);
8804 t
->static_trace_marker_id
.assign (p
, endp
- p
);
8806 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8808 t
->static_trace_marker_id
.c_str ());
8810 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal
.pc
, &marker
))
8812 t
->static_trace_marker_id
= std::move (marker
.str_id
);
8814 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8816 t
->static_trace_marker_id
.c_str ());
8819 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
8820 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
8827 loc
= add_location_to_breakpoint (b
, &sal
);
8828 if ((flags
& CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED
) != 0)
8834 const char *arg
= b
->cond_string
;
8836 loc
->cond
= parse_exp_1 (&arg
, loc
->address
,
8837 block_for_pc (loc
->address
), 0);
8839 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), arg
);
8842 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
8843 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
8844 if (type
== bp_dprintf
)
8846 if (b
->extra_string
)
8847 update_dprintf_command_list (b
);
8849 error (_("Format string required"));
8851 else if (b
->extra_string
)
8852 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b
->extra_string
);
8855 b
->display_canonical
= display_canonical
;
8856 if (location
!= NULL
)
8857 b
->location
= std::move (location
);
8859 b
->location
= new_address_location (b
->loc
->address
, NULL
, 0);
8860 b
->filter
= std::move (filter
);
8864 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
8865 gdb::array_view
<const symtab_and_line
> sals
,
8866 event_location_up
&&location
,
8867 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> filter
,
8868 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> cond_string
,
8869 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> extra_string
,
8870 enum bptype type
, enum bpdisp disposition
,
8871 int thread
, int task
, int ignore_count
,
8872 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
, int from_tty
,
8873 int enabled
, int internal
, unsigned flags
,
8874 int display_canonical
)
8876 std::unique_ptr
<breakpoint
> b
= new_breakpoint_from_type (type
);
8878 init_breakpoint_sal (b
.get (), gdbarch
,
8879 sals
, std::move (location
),
8881 std::move (cond_string
),
8882 std::move (extra_string
),
8884 thread
, task
, ignore_count
,
8886 enabled
, internal
, flags
,
8889 install_breakpoint (internal
, std::move (b
), 0);
8892 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
8893 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
8894 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
8895 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
8896 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
8897 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
8898 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
8899 we take just a single condition string.
8901 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
8902 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
8903 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
8904 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
8905 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
8908 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
8909 struct linespec_result
*canonical
,
8910 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> cond_string
,
8911 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> extra_string
,
8912 enum bptype type
, enum bpdisp disposition
,
8913 int thread
, int task
, int ignore_count
,
8914 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
, int from_tty
,
8915 int enabled
, int internal
, unsigned flags
)
8917 if (canonical
->pre_expanded
)
8918 gdb_assert (canonical
->lsals
.size () == 1);
8920 for (const auto &lsal
: canonical
->lsals
)
8922 /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain
8923 'break', without arguments. */
8924 event_location_up location
8925 = (canonical
->location
!= NULL
8926 ? copy_event_location (canonical
->location
.get ()) : NULL
);
8927 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> filter_string
8928 (lsal
.canonical
!= NULL
? xstrdup (lsal
.canonical
) : NULL
);
8930 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch
, lsal
.sals
,
8931 std::move (location
),
8932 std::move (filter_string
),
8933 std::move (cond_string
),
8934 std::move (extra_string
),
8936 thread
, task
, ignore_count
, ops
,
8937 from_tty
, enabled
, internal
, flags
,
8938 canonical
->special_display
);
8942 /* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
8943 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
8944 addresses found. LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for
8945 linespec locations).
8947 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
8948 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
8951 parse_breakpoint_sals (struct event_location
*location
,
8952 struct linespec_result
*canonical
)
8954 struct symtab_and_line cursal
;
8956 if (event_location_type (location
) == LINESPEC_LOCATION
)
8958 const char *spec
= get_linespec_location (location
)->spec_string
;
8962 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default
8963 breakpoint address. */
8964 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
8966 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
8967 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
8968 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
8969 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
8970 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
8971 symtab_and_line sal
= get_last_displayed_sal ();
8972 CORE_ADDR pc
= sal
.pc
;
8974 sal
= find_pc_line (pc
, 0);
8976 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
8977 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
8978 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
8979 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
8980 instances with the same symtab and line. */
8982 sal
.explicit_pc
= 1;
8984 struct linespec_sals lsal
;
8986 lsal
.canonical
= NULL
;
8988 canonical
->lsals
.push_back (std::move (lsal
));
8992 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
8996 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
8997 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
8998 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
8999 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
9001 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
9002 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
9003 cursal
= get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
9004 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9006 const char *spec
= NULL
;
9008 if (event_location_type (location
) == LINESPEC_LOCATION
)
9009 spec
= get_linespec_location (location
)->spec_string
;
9013 && strchr ("+-", spec
[0]) != NULL
9016 decode_line_full (location
, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
, NULL
,
9017 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
9018 get_last_displayed_line (),
9019 canonical
, NULL
, NULL
);
9024 decode_line_full (location
, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
, NULL
,
9025 cursal
.symtab
, cursal
.line
, canonical
, NULL
, NULL
);
9029 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
9030 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
9033 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (std::vector
<symtab_and_line
> &sals
)
9035 for (auto &sal
: sals
)
9036 resolve_sal_pc (&sal
);
9039 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
9040 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
9041 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
9042 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
9043 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
9047 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
9048 gdb::array_view
<const symtab_and_line
> sals
)
9050 for (const auto &sal
: sals
)
9052 struct gdbarch
*sarch
;
9054 sarch
= get_sal_arch (sal
);
9055 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
9056 associated with SAL. */
9060 if (!gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch
, sal
.pc
, &msg
))
9061 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at %s%s"),
9062 paddress (sarch
, sal
.pc
), msg
.c_str ());
9066 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
9067 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
9068 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
9069 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
9070 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
9071 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
9074 find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok
, CORE_ADDR pc
,
9075 char **cond_string
, int *thread
, int *task
,
9078 *cond_string
= NULL
;
9085 const char *end_tok
;
9087 const char *cond_start
= NULL
;
9088 const char *cond_end
= NULL
;
9090 tok
= skip_spaces (tok
);
9092 if ((*tok
== '"' || *tok
== ',') && rest
)
9094 *rest
= savestring (tok
, strlen (tok
));
9098 end_tok
= skip_to_space (tok
);
9100 toklen
= end_tok
- tok
;
9102 if (toklen
>= 1 && strncmp (tok
, "if", toklen
) == 0)
9104 tok
= cond_start
= end_tok
+ 1;
9105 parse_exp_1 (&tok
, pc
, block_for_pc (pc
), 0);
9107 *cond_string
= savestring (cond_start
, cond_end
- cond_start
);
9109 else if (toklen
>= 1 && strncmp (tok
, "thread", toklen
) == 0)
9112 struct thread_info
*thr
;
9115 thr
= parse_thread_id (tok
, &tmptok
);
9117 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
9118 *thread
= thr
->global_num
;
9121 else if (toklen
>= 1 && strncmp (tok
, "task", toklen
) == 0)
9126 *task
= strtol (tok
, &tmptok
, 0);
9128 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
9129 if (!valid_task_id (*task
))
9130 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task
);
9135 *rest
= savestring (tok
, strlen (tok
));
9139 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9143 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
9145 static std::vector
<symtab_and_line
>
9146 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p
)
9148 const char *p
= &(*arg_p
)[3];
9151 p
= skip_spaces (p
);
9153 endp
= skip_to_space (p
);
9155 std::string
marker_str (p
, endp
- p
);
9157 std::vector
<static_tracepoint_marker
> markers
9158 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str
.c_str ());
9159 if (markers
.empty ())
9160 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"),
9161 marker_str
.c_str ());
9163 std::vector
<symtab_and_line
> sals
;
9164 sals
.reserve (markers
.size ());
9166 for (const static_tracepoint_marker
&marker
: markers
)
9168 symtab_and_line sal
= find_pc_line (marker
.address
, 0);
9169 sal
.pc
= marker
.address
;
9170 sals
.push_back (sal
);
9177 /* Returns the breakpoint ops appropriate for use with with LOCATION_TYPE and
9178 according to IS_TRACEPOINT. */
9180 static const struct breakpoint_ops
*
9181 breakpoint_ops_for_event_location_type (enum event_location_type location_type
,
9186 if (location_type
== PROBE_LOCATION
)
9187 return &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops
;
9189 return &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops
;
9193 if (location_type
== PROBE_LOCATION
)
9194 return &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops
;
9196 return &bkpt_breakpoint_ops
;
9200 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9202 const struct breakpoint_ops
*
9203 breakpoint_ops_for_event_location (const struct event_location
*location
,
9206 if (location
!= nullptr)
9207 return breakpoint_ops_for_event_location_type
9208 (event_location_type (location
), is_tracepoint
);
9209 return is_tracepoint
? &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops
: &bkpt_breakpoint_ops
;
9212 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9215 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
9216 struct event_location
*location
,
9217 const char *cond_string
,
9218 int thread
, const char *extra_string
,
9220 int tempflag
, enum bptype type_wanted
,
9222 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support
,
9223 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
,
9224 int from_tty
, int enabled
, int internal
,
9227 struct linespec_result canonical
;
9230 int prev_bkpt_count
= breakpoint_count
;
9232 gdb_assert (ops
!= NULL
);
9234 /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */
9235 if (extra_string
!= NULL
&& *extra_string
== '\0')
9236 extra_string
= NULL
;
9240 ops
->create_sals_from_location (location
, &canonical
, type_wanted
);
9242 catch (const gdb_exception_error
&e
)
9244 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set
9246 if (e
.error
== NOT_FOUND_ERROR
)
9248 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9251 if (pending_break_support
== AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE
)
9254 exception_print (gdb_stderr
, e
);
9256 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9257 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9258 if (pending_break_support
== AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9259 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9260 bptype_string (type_wanted
)))
9263 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9264 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9265 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9266 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9273 if (!pending
&& canonical
.lsals
.empty ())
9276 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
9277 are ok for the target. */
9280 for (auto &lsal
: canonical
.lsals
)
9281 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (lsal
.sals
);
9284 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
9285 if (!pending
&& type_wanted
== bp_fast_tracepoint
)
9287 for (const auto &lsal
: canonical
.lsals
)
9288 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch
, lsal
.sals
);
9291 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
9292 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
9296 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> cond_string_copy
;
9297 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> extra_string_copy
;
9304 const linespec_sals
&lsal
= canonical
.lsals
[0];
9306 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
9307 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
9308 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
9309 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
9311 find_condition_and_thread (extra_string
, lsal
.sals
[0].pc
,
9312 &cond
, &thread
, &task
, &rest
);
9313 cond_string_copy
.reset (cond
);
9314 extra_string_copy
.reset (rest
);
9318 if (type_wanted
!= bp_dprintf
9319 && extra_string
!= NULL
&& *extra_string
!= '\0')
9320 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string
);
9322 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9324 cond_string_copy
.reset (xstrdup (cond_string
));
9325 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9327 extra_string_copy
.reset (xstrdup (extra_string
));
9330 ops
->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch
, &canonical
,
9331 std::move (cond_string_copy
),
9332 std::move (extra_string_copy
),
9334 tempflag
? disp_del
: disp_donttouch
,
9335 thread
, task
, ignore_count
, ops
,
9336 from_tty
, enabled
, internal
, flags
);
9340 std::unique_ptr
<breakpoint
> b
= new_breakpoint_from_type (type_wanted
);
9342 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b
.get (), gdbarch
, type_wanted
, ops
);
9343 b
->location
= copy_event_location (location
);
9346 b
->cond_string
= NULL
;
9349 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9350 b
->cond_string
= cond_string
!= NULL
? xstrdup (cond_string
) : NULL
;
9354 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9355 b
->extra_string
= extra_string
!= NULL
? xstrdup (extra_string
) : NULL
;
9356 b
->ignore_count
= ignore_count
;
9357 b
->disposition
= tempflag
? disp_del
: disp_donttouch
;
9358 b
->condition_not_parsed
= 1;
9359 b
->enable_state
= enabled
? bp_enabled
: bp_disabled
;
9360 if ((type_wanted
!= bp_breakpoint
9361 && type_wanted
!= bp_hardware_breakpoint
) || thread
!= -1)
9362 b
->pspace
= current_program_space
;
9364 install_breakpoint (internal
, std::move (b
), 0);
9367 if (canonical
.lsals
.size () > 1)
9369 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
9370 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
9371 prev_breakpoint_count
= prev_bkpt_count
;
9374 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT
);
9379 /* Set a breakpoint.
9380 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
9381 condition, and thread.
9382 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
9383 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
9387 break_command_1 (const char *arg
, int flag
, int from_tty
)
9389 int tempflag
= flag
& BP_TEMPFLAG
;
9390 enum bptype type_wanted
= (flag
& BP_HARDWAREFLAG
9391 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
9394 event_location_up location
= string_to_event_location (&arg
, current_language
);
9395 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
= breakpoint_ops_for_event_location
9396 (location
.get (), false /* is_tracepoint */);
9398 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9400 NULL
, 0, arg
, 1 /* parse arg */,
9401 tempflag
, type_wanted
,
9402 0 /* Ignore count */,
9403 pending_break_support
,
9411 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
9414 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line
*sal
)
9418 if (sal
->pc
== 0 && sal
->symtab
!= NULL
)
9420 if (!find_line_pc (sal
->symtab
, sal
->line
, &pc
))
9421 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
9422 sal
->line
, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal
->symtab
));
9425 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
9426 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
9427 if (sal
->explicit_line
)
9428 skip_prologue_sal (sal
);
9431 if (sal
->section
== 0 && sal
->symtab
!= NULL
)
9433 const struct blockvector
*bv
;
9434 const struct block
*b
;
9437 bv
= blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal
->pc
, 0, &b
,
9438 SYMTAB_COMPUNIT (sal
->symtab
));
9441 sym
= block_linkage_function (b
);
9444 fixup_symbol_section (sym
, SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal
->symtab
));
9445 sal
->section
= SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal
->symtab
),
9450 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
9451 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
9452 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
9453 happen in assembly source). */
9455 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread
;
9456 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal
->pspace
);
9458 bound_minimal_symbol msym
= lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal
->pc
);
9460 sal
->section
= MSYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym
.objfile
, msym
.minsym
);
9467 break_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
9469 break_command_1 (arg
, 0, from_tty
);
9473 tbreak_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
9475 break_command_1 (arg
, BP_TEMPFLAG
, from_tty
);
9479 hbreak_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
9481 break_command_1 (arg
, BP_HARDWAREFLAG
, from_tty
);
9485 thbreak_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
9487 break_command_1 (arg
, (BP_TEMPFLAG
| BP_HARDWAREFLAG
), from_tty
);
9491 stop_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
9493 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
9494 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
9495 stop at <line>\n"));
9499 stopin_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
9505 else if (*arg
!= '*')
9507 const char *argptr
= arg
;
9510 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
9511 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
9512 function/method name. */
9513 while (*argptr
&& !hasColon
)
9515 hasColon
= (*argptr
== ':');
9520 badInput
= (*argptr
!= ':'); /* Not a class::method */
9522 badInput
= isdigit (*arg
); /* a simple line number */
9526 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
9528 break_command_1 (arg
, 0, from_tty
);
9532 stopat_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
9536 if (arg
== NULL
|| *arg
== '*') /* no line number */
9540 const char *argptr
= arg
;
9543 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
9544 it is probably a line number. */
9545 while (*argptr
&& !hasColon
)
9547 hasColon
= (*argptr
== ':');
9552 badInput
= (*argptr
== ':'); /* we have class::method */
9554 badInput
= !isdigit (*arg
); /* not a line number */
9558 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at LINE\n"));
9560 break_command_1 (arg
, 0, from_tty
);
9563 /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
9564 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
9565 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
9569 dprintf_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
9571 event_location_up location
= string_to_event_location (&arg
, current_language
);
9573 /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location;
9574 the next character must be ','. */
9577 if (arg
[0] != ',' || arg
[1] == '\0')
9578 error (_("Format string required"));
9581 /* Skip the comma. */
9586 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9588 NULL
, 0, arg
, 1 /* parse arg */,
9590 0 /* Ignore count */,
9591 pending_break_support
,
9592 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops
,
9600 agent_printf_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
9602 error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
9605 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
9606 ranged breakpoints. */
9609 breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location
*bl
,
9610 const address_space
*aspace
,
9612 const struct target_waitstatus
*ws
)
9614 if (ws
->kind
!= TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
9615 || ws
->value
.sig
!= GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP
)
9618 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl
->pspace
->aspace
, bl
->address
,
9619 bl
->length
, aspace
, bp_addr
);
9622 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
9623 ranged breakpoints. */
9626 resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location
*bl
)
9628 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9631 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
9632 ranged breakpoints. */
9634 static enum print_stop_action
9635 print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs
)
9637 struct breakpoint
*b
= bs
->breakpoint_at
;
9638 struct bp_location
*bl
= b
->loc
;
9639 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
9641 gdb_assert (b
->type
== bp_hardware_breakpoint
);
9643 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9644 gdb_assert (bl
&& bl
->next
== NULL
);
9646 annotate_breakpoint (b
->number
);
9648 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout
);
9650 if (b
->disposition
== disp_del
)
9651 uiout
->text ("Temporary ranged breakpoint ");
9653 uiout
->text ("Ranged breakpoint ");
9654 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
9656 uiout
->field_string ("reason",
9657 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT
));
9658 uiout
->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b
->disposition
));
9660 uiout
->field_signed ("bkptno", b
->number
);
9663 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
;
9666 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
9667 ranged breakpoints. */
9670 print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint
*b
,
9671 struct bp_location
**last_loc
)
9673 struct bp_location
*bl
= b
->loc
;
9674 struct value_print_options opts
;
9675 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
9677 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9678 gdb_assert (bl
&& bl
->next
== NULL
);
9680 get_user_print_options (&opts
);
9682 if (opts
.addressprint
)
9683 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
9684 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
9685 uiout
->field_skip ("addr");
9687 print_breakpoint_location (b
, bl
);
9691 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
9692 ranged breakpoints. */
9695 print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint
*b
,
9696 struct ui_out
*uiout
)
9698 CORE_ADDR address_start
, address_end
;
9699 struct bp_location
*bl
= b
->loc
;
9704 address_start
= bl
->address
;
9705 address_end
= address_start
+ bl
->length
- 1;
9707 uiout
->text ("\taddress range: ");
9708 stb
.printf ("[%s, %s]",
9709 print_core_address (bl
->gdbarch
, address_start
),
9710 print_core_address (bl
->gdbarch
, address_end
));
9711 uiout
->field_stream ("addr", stb
);
9715 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
9716 ranged breakpoints. */
9719 print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint
*b
)
9721 struct bp_location
*bl
= b
->loc
;
9722 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
9725 gdb_assert (b
->type
== bp_hardware_breakpoint
);
9727 uiout
->message (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
9728 b
->number
, paddress (bl
->gdbarch
, bl
->address
),
9729 paddress (bl
->gdbarch
, bl
->address
+ bl
->length
- 1));
9732 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
9733 ranged breakpoints. */
9736 print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct ui_file
*fp
)
9738 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "break-range %s, %s",
9739 event_location_to_string (b
->location
.get ()),
9740 event_location_to_string (b
->location_range_end
.get ()));
9741 print_recreate_thread (b
, fp
);
9744 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
9746 static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops
;
9748 /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
9749 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
9750 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
9751 last instruction of the given line. */
9754 find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal
)
9758 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
9759 find the address of the end of the given location. */
9760 if (sal
.explicit_pc
)
9767 ret
= find_line_pc_range (sal
, &start
, &end
);
9769 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9771 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
9778 /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
9781 break_range_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
9783 const char *arg_start
;
9784 struct linespec_result canonical_start
, canonical_end
;
9785 int bp_count
, can_use_bp
, length
;
9787 struct breakpoint
*b
;
9789 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
9790 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
9791 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
9793 bp_count
= hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9794 bp_count
+= target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9795 can_use_bp
= target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint
,
9798 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9800 arg
= skip_spaces (arg
);
9801 if (arg
== NULL
|| arg
[0] == '\0')
9802 error(_("No address range specified."));
9805 event_location_up start_location
= string_to_event_location (&arg
,
9807 parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location
.get (), &canonical_start
);
9810 error (_("Too few arguments."));
9811 else if (canonical_start
.lsals
.empty ())
9812 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
9814 const linespec_sals
&lsal_start
= canonical_start
.lsals
[0];
9816 if (canonical_start
.lsals
.size () > 1
9817 || lsal_start
.sals
.size () != 1)
9818 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9820 const symtab_and_line
&sal_start
= lsal_start
.sals
[0];
9821 std::string
addr_string_start (arg_start
, arg
- arg_start
);
9823 arg
++; /* Skip the comma. */
9824 arg
= skip_spaces (arg
);
9826 /* Parse the end location. */
9830 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
9831 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
9832 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
9833 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
9834 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
9835 event_location_up end_location
= string_to_event_location (&arg
,
9837 decode_line_full (end_location
.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
, NULL
,
9838 sal_start
.symtab
, sal_start
.line
,
9839 &canonical_end
, NULL
, NULL
);
9841 if (canonical_end
.lsals
.empty ())
9842 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9844 const linespec_sals
&lsal_end
= canonical_end
.lsals
[0];
9845 if (canonical_end
.lsals
.size () > 1
9846 || lsal_end
.sals
.size () != 1)
9847 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9849 const symtab_and_line
&sal_end
= lsal_end
.sals
[0];
9851 end
= find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end
);
9852 if (sal_start
.pc
> end
)
9853 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
9855 length
= end
- sal_start
.pc
+ 1;
9857 /* Length overflowed. */
9858 error (_("Address range too large."));
9859 else if (length
== 1)
9861 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
9862 the `hbreak' command. */
9863 hbreak_command (&addr_string_start
[0], 1);
9868 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
9869 b
= set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start
,
9870 bp_hardware_breakpoint
, &ranged_breakpoint_ops
);
9871 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count
+ 1);
9872 b
->number
= breakpoint_count
;
9873 b
->disposition
= disp_donttouch
;
9874 b
->location
= std::move (start_location
);
9875 b
->location_range_end
= std::move (end_location
);
9876 b
->loc
->length
= length
;
9879 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created
.notify (b
);
9880 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT
);
9883 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
9884 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
9885 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
9889 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression
*exp
)
9897 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
9898 operator_length (exp
, i
, &oplenp
, &argsp
);
9901 switch (exp
->elts
[i
].opcode
)
9911 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND
:
9912 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR
:
9913 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND
:
9914 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR
:
9915 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR
:
9917 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL
:
9943 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING
:
9946 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT
:
9947 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT
:
9952 case UNOP_CAST_TYPE
:
9953 case UNOP_REINTERPRET_CAST
:
9954 case UNOP_DYNAMIC_CAST
:
9955 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
9956 their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
9957 result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
9958 determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
9960 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
9961 value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
9966 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
9968 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
9969 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
9970 constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
9971 true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
9973 We also have to check for function symbols because they
9974 are always constant. */
9976 struct symbol
*s
= exp
->elts
[i
+ 2].symbol
;
9978 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s
) != LOC_BLOCK
9979 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s
) != LOC_CONST
9980 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s
) != LOC_CONST_BYTES
)
9985 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
9986 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
9987 then it is not a constant. */
9996 /* Watchpoint destructor. */
9998 watchpoint::~watchpoint ()
10000 xfree (this->exp_string
);
10001 xfree (this->exp_string_reparse
);
10004 /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10007 re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint
*b
)
10009 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) b
;
10011 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10012 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10014 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
10015 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
10016 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
10017 are loaded and unloaded.
10019 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
10020 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
10021 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
10022 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
10023 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
10024 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
10026 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10027 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
10028 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
10029 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10031 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10032 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10034 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
10035 reevaluated again when enabled. */
10036 update_watchpoint (w
, 1 /* reparse */);
10039 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10042 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location
*bl
)
10044 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) bl
->owner
;
10045 int length
= w
->exact
? 1 : bl
->length
;
10047 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl
->address
, length
, bl
->watchpoint_type
,
10048 w
->cond_exp
.get ());
10051 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10054 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location
*bl
, enum remove_bp_reason reason
)
10056 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) bl
->owner
;
10057 int length
= w
->exact
? 1 : bl
->length
;
10059 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl
->address
, length
, bl
->watchpoint_type
,
10060 w
->cond_exp
.get ());
10064 breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location
*bl
,
10065 const address_space
*aspace
, CORE_ADDR bp_addr
,
10066 const struct target_waitstatus
*ws
)
10068 struct breakpoint
*b
= bl
->owner
;
10069 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) b
;
10071 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
10072 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
10073 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
10074 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
10075 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
10076 (did not match the data address). */
10077 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b
)
10078 && w
->watchpoint_triggered
== watch_triggered_no
)
10085 check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs
)
10087 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs
->breakpoint_at
));
10089 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs
);
10092 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10093 hardware watchpoints. */
10096 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location
*bl
)
10098 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) bl
->owner
;
10099 int length
= w
->exact
? 1 : bl
->length
;
10101 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl
->address
, length
);
10104 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10105 hardware watchpoints. */
10108 works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint
*b
)
10110 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
10111 return b
->type
== bp_watchpoint
|| b
->type
== bp_hardware_watchpoint
;
10114 static enum print_stop_action
10115 print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs
)
10117 struct breakpoint
*b
;
10118 enum print_stop_action result
;
10119 struct watchpoint
*w
;
10120 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
10122 gdb_assert (bs
->bp_location_at
!= NULL
);
10124 b
= bs
->breakpoint_at
;
10125 w
= (struct watchpoint
*) b
;
10127 annotate_watchpoint (b
->number
);
10128 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout
);
10132 gdb::optional
<ui_out_emit_tuple
> tuple_emitter
;
10135 case bp_watchpoint
:
10136 case bp_hardware_watchpoint
:
10137 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
10138 uiout
->field_string
10139 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER
));
10141 tuple_emitter
.emplace (uiout
, "value");
10142 uiout
->text ("\nOld value = ");
10143 watchpoint_value_print (bs
->old_val
.get (), &stb
);
10144 uiout
->field_stream ("old", stb
);
10145 uiout
->text ("\nNew value = ");
10146 watchpoint_value_print (w
->val
.get (), &stb
);
10147 uiout
->field_stream ("new", stb
);
10148 uiout
->text ("\n");
10149 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10150 result
= PRINT_UNKNOWN
;
10153 case bp_read_watchpoint
:
10154 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
10155 uiout
->field_string
10156 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER
));
10158 tuple_emitter
.emplace (uiout
, "value");
10159 uiout
->text ("\nValue = ");
10160 watchpoint_value_print (w
->val
.get (), &stb
);
10161 uiout
->field_stream ("value", stb
);
10162 uiout
->text ("\n");
10163 result
= PRINT_UNKNOWN
;
10166 case bp_access_watchpoint
:
10167 if (bs
->old_val
!= NULL
)
10169 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
10170 uiout
->field_string
10172 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER
));
10174 tuple_emitter
.emplace (uiout
, "value");
10175 uiout
->text ("\nOld value = ");
10176 watchpoint_value_print (bs
->old_val
.get (), &stb
);
10177 uiout
->field_stream ("old", stb
);
10178 uiout
->text ("\nNew value = ");
10183 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
10184 uiout
->field_string
10186 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER
));
10187 tuple_emitter
.emplace (uiout
, "value");
10188 uiout
->text ("\nValue = ");
10190 watchpoint_value_print (w
->val
.get (), &stb
);
10191 uiout
->field_stream ("new", stb
);
10192 uiout
->text ("\n");
10193 result
= PRINT_UNKNOWN
;
10196 result
= PRINT_UNKNOWN
;
10202 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
10206 print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint
*b
)
10208 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) b
;
10209 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
10210 const char *tuple_name
;
10214 case bp_watchpoint
:
10215 uiout
->text ("Watchpoint ");
10216 tuple_name
= "wpt";
10218 case bp_hardware_watchpoint
:
10219 uiout
->text ("Hardware watchpoint ");
10220 tuple_name
= "wpt";
10222 case bp_read_watchpoint
:
10223 uiout
->text ("Hardware read watchpoint ");
10224 tuple_name
= "hw-rwpt";
10226 case bp_access_watchpoint
:
10227 uiout
->text ("Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10228 tuple_name
= "hw-awpt";
10231 internal_error (__FILE__
, __LINE__
,
10232 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10235 ui_out_emit_tuple
tuple_emitter (uiout
, tuple_name
);
10236 uiout
->field_signed ("number", b
->number
);
10237 uiout
->text (": ");
10238 uiout
->field_string ("exp", w
->exp_string
);
10241 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10245 print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct ui_file
*fp
)
10247 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) b
;
10251 case bp_watchpoint
:
10252 case bp_hardware_watchpoint
:
10253 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "watch");
10255 case bp_read_watchpoint
:
10256 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "rwatch");
10258 case bp_access_watchpoint
:
10259 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "awatch");
10262 internal_error (__FILE__
, __LINE__
,
10263 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
10266 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, " %s", w
->exp_string
);
10267 print_recreate_thread (b
, fp
);
10270 /* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
10274 explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint
*b
, enum gdb_signal sig
)
10276 /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
10277 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
10278 if (b
->type
== bp_watchpoint
&& sig
!= GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP
)
10284 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
10286 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops
;
10288 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
10289 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10292 insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location
*bl
)
10294 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) bl
->owner
;
10296 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl
->address
, w
->hw_wp_mask
,
10297 bl
->watchpoint_type
);
10300 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
10301 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10304 remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location
*bl
, enum remove_bp_reason reason
)
10306 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) bl
->owner
;
10308 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl
->address
, w
->hw_wp_mask
,
10309 bl
->watchpoint_type
);
10312 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10313 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10316 resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location
*bl
)
10318 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) bl
->owner
;
10320 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl
->address
, w
->hw_wp_mask
);
10323 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10324 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10327 works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint
*b
)
10332 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10333 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10335 static enum print_stop_action
10336 print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs
)
10338 struct breakpoint
*b
= bs
->breakpoint_at
;
10339 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
10341 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10342 gdb_assert (b
->loc
&& b
->loc
->next
== NULL
);
10344 annotate_watchpoint (b
->number
);
10345 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout
);
10349 case bp_hardware_watchpoint
:
10350 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
10351 uiout
->field_string
10352 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER
));
10355 case bp_read_watchpoint
:
10356 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
10357 uiout
->field_string
10358 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER
));
10361 case bp_access_watchpoint
:
10362 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
10363 uiout
->field_string
10365 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER
));
10368 internal_error (__FILE__
, __LINE__
,
10369 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10373 uiout
->text (_("\n\
10374 Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
10375 address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
10376 uiout
->text ("\n");
10378 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10379 return PRINT_UNKNOWN
;
10382 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10383 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10386 print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint
*b
,
10387 struct ui_out
*uiout
)
10389 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) b
;
10391 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10392 gdb_assert (b
->loc
&& b
->loc
->next
== NULL
);
10394 uiout
->text ("\tmask ");
10395 uiout
->field_core_addr ("mask", b
->loc
->gdbarch
, w
->hw_wp_mask
);
10396 uiout
->text ("\n");
10399 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10400 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10403 print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint
*b
)
10405 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) b
;
10406 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
10407 const char *tuple_name
;
10411 case bp_hardware_watchpoint
:
10412 uiout
->text ("Masked hardware watchpoint ");
10413 tuple_name
= "wpt";
10415 case bp_read_watchpoint
:
10416 uiout
->text ("Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
10417 tuple_name
= "hw-rwpt";
10419 case bp_access_watchpoint
:
10420 uiout
->text ("Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10421 tuple_name
= "hw-awpt";
10424 internal_error (__FILE__
, __LINE__
,
10425 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10428 ui_out_emit_tuple
tuple_emitter (uiout
, tuple_name
);
10429 uiout
->field_signed ("number", b
->number
);
10430 uiout
->text (": ");
10431 uiout
->field_string ("exp", w
->exp_string
);
10434 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10435 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10438 print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct ui_file
*fp
)
10440 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) b
;
10444 case bp_hardware_watchpoint
:
10445 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "watch");
10447 case bp_read_watchpoint
:
10448 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "rwatch");
10450 case bp_access_watchpoint
:
10451 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "awatch");
10454 internal_error (__FILE__
, __LINE__
,
10455 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10458 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, " %s mask 0x%s", w
->exp_string
,
10459 phex (w
->hw_wp_mask
, sizeof (CORE_ADDR
)));
10460 print_recreate_thread (b
, fp
);
10463 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
10465 static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops
;
10467 /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
10470 is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint
*b
)
10472 return b
->ops
== &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops
;
10475 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
10476 hw_read: watch read,
10477 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
10479 watch_command_1 (const char *arg
, int accessflag
, int from_tty
,
10480 int just_location
, int internal
)
10482 struct breakpoint
*scope_breakpoint
= NULL
;
10483 const struct block
*exp_valid_block
= NULL
, *cond_exp_valid_block
= NULL
;
10484 struct value
*result
;
10485 int saved_bitpos
= 0, saved_bitsize
= 0;
10486 const char *exp_start
= NULL
;
10487 const char *exp_end
= NULL
;
10488 const char *tok
, *end_tok
;
10490 const char *cond_start
= NULL
;
10491 const char *cond_end
= NULL
;
10492 enum bptype bp_type
;
10495 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
10496 the hardware watchpoint. */
10498 CORE_ADDR mask
= 0;
10500 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
10501 if (arg
!= NULL
&& arg
[0] != '\0')
10503 const char *value_start
;
10505 exp_end
= arg
+ strlen (arg
);
10507 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
10508 of the arguments string. */
10509 for (tok
= exp_end
- 1; tok
> arg
; tok
--)
10511 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
10512 while (tok
> arg
&& (*tok
== ' ' || *tok
== '\t'))
10515 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
10516 This is the value of the parameter. */
10517 while (tok
> arg
&& (*tok
!= ' ' && *tok
!= '\t'))
10519 value_start
= tok
+ 1;
10521 /* Skip whitespace. */
10522 while (tok
> arg
&& (*tok
== ' ' || *tok
== '\t'))
10527 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
10528 This is the parameter itself. */
10529 while (tok
> arg
&& (*tok
!= ' ' && *tok
!= '\t'))
10532 toklen
= end_tok
- tok
+ 1;
10534 if (toklen
== 6 && startswith (tok
, "thread"))
10536 struct thread_info
*thr
;
10537 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
10538 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
10539 only in a specific thread. */
10543 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
10545 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
10546 thr
= parse_thread_id (value_start
, &endp
);
10548 /* Check if the user provided a valid thread ID. */
10549 if (*endp
!= ' ' && *endp
!= '\t' && *endp
!= '\0')
10550 invalid_thread_id_error (value_start
);
10552 thread
= thr
->global_num
;
10554 else if (toklen
== 4 && startswith (tok
, "mask"))
10556 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
10557 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
10559 struct value
*mask_value
, *mark
;
10562 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
10564 use_mask
= just_location
= 1;
10566 mark
= value_mark ();
10567 mask_value
= parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start
);
10568 mask
= value_as_address (mask_value
);
10569 value_free_to_mark (mark
);
10572 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
10575 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
10576 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
10583 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
10584 is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
10586 std::string
expression (arg
, exp_end
- arg
);
10587 exp_start
= arg
= expression
.c_str ();
10588 innermost_block_tracker tracker
;
10589 expression_up exp
= parse_exp_1 (&arg
, 0, 0, 0, &tracker
);
10591 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
10592 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
10594 while (exp_end
> exp_start
&& (exp_end
[-1] == ' ' || exp_end
[-1] == '\t'))
10597 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
10598 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp
.get ()))
10602 len
= exp_end
- exp_start
;
10603 while (len
> 0 && isspace (exp_start
[len
- 1]))
10605 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len
, exp_start
);
10608 exp_valid_block
= tracker
.block ();
10609 struct value
*mark
= value_mark ();
10610 struct value
*val_as_value
= nullptr;
10611 fetch_subexp_value (exp
.get (), &pc
, &val_as_value
, &result
, NULL
,
10614 if (val_as_value
!= NULL
&& just_location
)
10616 saved_bitpos
= value_bitpos (val_as_value
);
10617 saved_bitsize
= value_bitsize (val_as_value
);
10625 exp_valid_block
= NULL
;
10626 val
= release_value (value_addr (result
));
10627 value_free_to_mark (mark
);
10631 ret
= target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val
.get ()),
10634 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
10635 else if (ret
== -2)
10636 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
10639 else if (val_as_value
!= NULL
)
10640 val
= release_value (val_as_value
);
10642 tok
= skip_spaces (arg
);
10643 end_tok
= skip_to_space (tok
);
10645 toklen
= end_tok
- tok
;
10646 if (toklen
>= 1 && strncmp (tok
, "if", toklen
) == 0)
10648 tok
= cond_start
= end_tok
+ 1;
10649 innermost_block_tracker if_tracker
;
10650 parse_exp_1 (&tok
, 0, 0, 0, &if_tracker
);
10652 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
10653 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
10654 cond_exp_valid_block
= if_tracker
.block ();
10659 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
10661 frame_info
*wp_frame
= block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block
);
10663 /* Save this because create_internal_breakpoint below invalidates
10665 frame_id watchpoint_frame
= get_frame_id (wp_frame
);
10667 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
10668 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
10669 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
10670 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
10671 if (exp_valid_block
!= NULL
&& wp_frame
!= NULL
)
10673 frame_id caller_frame_id
= frame_unwind_caller_id (wp_frame
);
10675 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id
))
10677 gdbarch
*caller_arch
= frame_unwind_caller_arch (wp_frame
);
10678 CORE_ADDR caller_pc
= frame_unwind_caller_pc (wp_frame
);
10681 = create_internal_breakpoint (caller_arch
, caller_pc
,
10682 bp_watchpoint_scope
,
10683 &momentary_breakpoint_ops
);
10685 /* create_internal_breakpoint could invalidate WP_FRAME. */
10688 scope_breakpoint
->enable_state
= bp_enabled
;
10690 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
10691 scope_breakpoint
->disposition
= disp_del
;
10693 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
10694 scope_breakpoint
->frame_id
= caller_frame_id
;
10696 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
10697 scope_breakpoint
->loc
->gdbarch
= caller_arch
;
10698 scope_breakpoint
->loc
->requested_address
= caller_pc
;
10699 scope_breakpoint
->loc
->address
10700 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint
->loc
->gdbarch
,
10701 scope_breakpoint
->loc
->requested_address
,
10702 scope_breakpoint
->type
);
10706 /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
10707 watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
10708 to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
10709 drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
10711 if (accessflag
== hw_read
)
10712 bp_type
= bp_read_watchpoint
;
10713 else if (accessflag
== hw_access
)
10714 bp_type
= bp_access_watchpoint
;
10716 bp_type
= bp_hardware_watchpoint
;
10718 std::unique_ptr
<watchpoint
> w (new watchpoint ());
10721 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w
.get (), NULL
, bp_type
,
10722 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops
);
10724 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w
.get (), NULL
, bp_type
,
10725 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops
);
10726 w
->thread
= thread
;
10727 w
->disposition
= disp_donttouch
;
10728 w
->pspace
= current_program_space
;
10729 w
->exp
= std::move (exp
);
10730 w
->exp_valid_block
= exp_valid_block
;
10731 w
->cond_exp_valid_block
= cond_exp_valid_block
;
10734 struct type
*t
= value_type (val
.get ());
10735 CORE_ADDR addr
= value_as_address (val
.get ());
10737 w
->exp_string_reparse
10738 = current_language
->watch_location_expression (t
, addr
).release ();
10740 w
->exp_string
= xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
10741 (int) (exp_end
- exp_start
), exp_start
);
10744 w
->exp_string
= savestring (exp_start
, exp_end
- exp_start
);
10748 w
->hw_wp_mask
= mask
;
10753 w
->val_bitpos
= saved_bitpos
;
10754 w
->val_bitsize
= saved_bitsize
;
10755 w
->val_valid
= true;
10759 w
->cond_string
= savestring (cond_start
, cond_end
- cond_start
);
10761 w
->cond_string
= 0;
10763 if (frame_id_p (watchpoint_frame
))
10765 w
->watchpoint_frame
= watchpoint_frame
;
10766 w
->watchpoint_thread
= inferior_ptid
;
10770 w
->watchpoint_frame
= null_frame_id
;
10771 w
->watchpoint_thread
= null_ptid
;
10774 if (scope_breakpoint
!= NULL
)
10776 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
10777 need to act on them together. */
10778 w
->related_breakpoint
= scope_breakpoint
;
10779 scope_breakpoint
->related_breakpoint
= w
.get ();
10782 if (!just_location
)
10783 value_free_to_mark (mark
);
10785 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
10786 that should be inserted. */
10787 update_watchpoint (w
.get (), 1);
10789 install_breakpoint (internal
, std::move (w
), 1);
10792 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
10793 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
10796 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (const std::vector
<value_ref_ptr
> &vals
)
10798 int found_memory_cnt
= 0;
10800 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
10801 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints
)
10804 gdb_assert (!vals
.empty ());
10805 struct value
*head
= vals
[0].get ();
10807 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
10808 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
10809 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
10810 hardware watchpoint.
10812 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
10813 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
10814 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
10815 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
10816 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
10817 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
10818 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
10819 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
10820 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
10822 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
10823 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
10824 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
10825 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
10826 for (const value_ref_ptr
&iter
: vals
)
10828 struct value
*v
= iter
.get ();
10830 if (VALUE_LVAL (v
) == lval_memory
)
10832 if (v
!= head
&& value_lazy (v
))
10833 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
10834 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
10835 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
10836 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
10837 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
10841 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
10842 it with hardware watchpoints. */
10843 struct type
*vtype
= check_typedef (value_type (v
));
10845 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
10846 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
10847 middle of some value chain. */
10849 || (vtype
->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
10850 && vtype
->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
))
10852 CORE_ADDR vaddr
= value_address (v
);
10856 len
= (target_exact_watchpoints
10857 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype
))?
10858 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v
));
10860 num_regs
= target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr
, len
);
10864 found_memory_cnt
+= num_regs
;
10868 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v
) != not_lval
10869 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v
) == 0)
10870 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
10871 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v
) == lval_register
)
10872 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
10875 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
10876 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
10877 return found_memory_cnt
;
10881 watch_command_wrapper (const char *arg
, int from_tty
, int internal
)
10883 watch_command_1 (arg
, hw_write
, from_tty
, 0, internal
);
10886 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
10887 calls watch_command_1. */
10890 watch_maybe_just_location (const char *arg
, int accessflag
, int from_tty
)
10892 int just_location
= 0;
10895 && (check_for_argument (&arg
, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
10896 || check_for_argument (&arg
, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
10899 watch_command_1 (arg
, accessflag
, from_tty
, just_location
, 0);
10903 watch_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
10905 watch_maybe_just_location (arg
, hw_write
, from_tty
);
10909 rwatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg
, int from_tty
, int internal
)
10911 watch_command_1 (arg
, hw_read
, from_tty
, 0, internal
);
10915 rwatch_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
10917 watch_maybe_just_location (arg
, hw_read
, from_tty
);
10921 awatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg
, int from_tty
, int internal
)
10923 watch_command_1 (arg
, hw_access
, from_tty
, 0, internal
);
10927 awatch_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
10929 watch_maybe_just_location (arg
, hw_access
, from_tty
);
10933 /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands
10934 in infcmd.c. Here because it uses the mechanisms of
10937 struct until_break_fsm
: public thread_fsm
10939 /* The thread that was current when the command was executed. */
10942 /* The breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame,
10943 plus breakpoints at all the destination locations. */
10944 std::vector
<breakpoint_up
> breakpoints
;
10946 until_break_fsm (struct interp
*cmd_interp
, int thread
,
10947 std::vector
<breakpoint_up
> &&breakpoints
)
10948 : thread_fsm (cmd_interp
),
10950 breakpoints (std::move (breakpoints
))
10954 void clean_up (struct thread_info
*thread
) override
;
10955 bool should_stop (struct thread_info
*thread
) override
;
10956 enum async_reply_reason
do_async_reply_reason () override
;
10959 /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the
10960 until(location)/advance commands. */
10963 until_break_fsm::should_stop (struct thread_info
*tp
)
10965 for (const breakpoint_up
&bp
: breakpoints
)
10966 if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp
->control
.stop_bpstat
,
10967 bp
.get ()) != NULL
)
10976 /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the
10977 until(location)/advance commands. */
10980 until_break_fsm::clean_up (struct thread_info
*)
10982 /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints. */
10983 breakpoints
.clear ();
10984 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (thread
);
10987 /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the
10988 until(location)/advance commands. */
10990 enum async_reply_reason
10991 until_break_fsm::do_async_reply_reason ()
10993 return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED
;
10997 until_break_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
, int anywhere
)
10999 struct frame_info
*frame
;
11000 struct gdbarch
*frame_gdbarch
;
11001 struct frame_id stack_frame_id
;
11002 struct frame_id caller_frame_id
;
11004 struct thread_info
*tp
;
11006 clear_proceed_status (0);
11008 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
11011 event_location_up location
= string_to_event_location (&arg
, current_language
);
11013 std::vector
<symtab_and_line
> sals
11014 = (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()
11015 ? decode_line_1 (location
.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
, NULL
,
11016 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
11017 get_last_displayed_line ())
11018 : decode_line_1 (location
.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
,
11022 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
11025 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11027 tp
= inferior_thread ();
11028 thread
= tp
->global_num
;
11030 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
11031 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
11032 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
11035 frame
= get_selected_frame (NULL
);
11036 frame_gdbarch
= get_frame_arch (frame
);
11037 stack_frame_id
= get_stack_frame_id (frame
);
11038 caller_frame_id
= frame_unwind_caller_id (frame
);
11040 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
11043 std::vector
<breakpoint_up
> breakpoints
;
11045 gdb::optional
<delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup
> lj_deleter
;
11047 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id
))
11049 struct symtab_and_line sal2
;
11050 struct gdbarch
*caller_gdbarch
;
11052 sal2
= find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame
), 0);
11053 sal2
.pc
= frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame
);
11054 caller_gdbarch
= frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame
);
11056 breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint
11057 = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch
, sal2
,
11058 caller_frame_id
, bp_until
);
11059 breakpoints
.emplace_back (std::move (caller_breakpoint
));
11061 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp
, caller_frame_id
);
11062 lj_deleter
.emplace (thread
);
11065 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
11068 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location, we
11069 don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. Otherwise,
11070 specify the selected frame, because we want to stop only at the
11071 very same frame. */
11072 frame_id stop_frame_id
= anywhere
? null_frame_id
: stack_frame_id
;
11074 for (symtab_and_line
&sal
: sals
)
11076 resolve_sal_pc (&sal
);
11078 breakpoint_up location_breakpoint
11079 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch
, sal
,
11080 stop_frame_id
, bp_until
);
11081 breakpoints
.emplace_back (std::move (location_breakpoint
));
11084 tp
->thread_fsm
= new until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp
->global_num
,
11085 std::move (breakpoints
));
11088 lj_deleter
->release ();
11090 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT
);
11093 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
11094 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
11096 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
11097 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
11098 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
11099 if clause in the arg string. */
11102 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (const char **arg
)
11104 const char *cond_string
;
11106 if (((*arg
)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg
)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg
)[2]))
11109 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
11112 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
11113 condition string. */
11114 *arg
= skip_spaces (*arg
);
11115 cond_string
= *arg
;
11117 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
11119 (*arg
) += strlen (cond_string
);
11121 return cond_string
;
11124 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
11125 process start/exit, etc. */
11129 catch_fork_temporary
, catch_vfork_temporary
,
11130 catch_fork_permanent
, catch_vfork_permanent
11135 catch_fork_command_1 (const char *arg
, int from_tty
,
11136 struct cmd_list_element
*command
)
11138 struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
= get_current_arch ();
11139 const char *cond_string
= NULL
;
11140 catch_fork_kind fork_kind
;
11143 fork_kind
= (catch_fork_kind
) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command
);
11144 tempflag
= (fork_kind
== catch_fork_temporary
11145 || fork_kind
== catch_vfork_temporary
);
11149 arg
= skip_spaces (arg
);
11151 /* The allowed syntax is:
11153 catch [v]fork if <cond>
11155 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11156 cond_string
= ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg
);
11158 if ((*arg
!= '\0') && !isspace (*arg
))
11159 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11161 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
11162 and enable reporting of such events. */
11165 case catch_fork_temporary
:
11166 case catch_fork_permanent
:
11167 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch
, tempflag
, cond_string
,
11168 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops
);
11170 case catch_vfork_temporary
:
11171 case catch_vfork_permanent
:
11172 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch
, tempflag
, cond_string
,
11173 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops
);
11176 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
11182 catch_exec_command_1 (const char *arg
, int from_tty
,
11183 struct cmd_list_element
*command
)
11185 struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
= get_current_arch ();
11187 const char *cond_string
= NULL
;
11189 tempflag
= get_cmd_context (command
) == CATCH_TEMPORARY
;
11193 arg
= skip_spaces (arg
);
11195 /* The allowed syntax is:
11197 catch exec if <cond>
11199 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11200 cond_string
= ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg
);
11202 if ((*arg
!= '\0') && !isspace (*arg
))
11203 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11205 std::unique_ptr
<exec_catchpoint
> c (new exec_catchpoint ());
11206 init_catchpoint (c
.get (), gdbarch
, tempflag
, cond_string
,
11207 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops
);
11208 c
->exec_pathname
= NULL
;
11210 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c
), 1);
11214 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint
*b
,
11215 struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
11216 struct symtab_and_line sal
,
11217 const char *addr_string
,
11218 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
,
11225 struct gdbarch
*loc_gdbarch
= get_sal_arch (sal
);
11227 loc_gdbarch
= gdbarch
;
11229 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch
,
11230 sal
.pspace
, sal
.pc
, sal
.section
, -1);
11231 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
11232 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
11233 used for different exception names will use the same address.
11234 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
11235 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
11236 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
11237 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
11238 enough for now, though. */
11241 init_raw_breakpoint (b
, gdbarch
, sal
, bp_catchpoint
, ops
);
11243 b
->enable_state
= enabled
? bp_enabled
: bp_disabled
;
11244 b
->disposition
= tempflag
? disp_del
: disp_donttouch
;
11245 b
->location
= string_to_event_location (&addr_string
,
11246 language_def (language_ada
));
11247 b
->language
= language_ada
;
11252 /* Compare two breakpoints and return a strcmp-like result. */
11255 compare_breakpoints (const breakpoint
*a
, const breakpoint
*b
)
11257 uintptr_t ua
= (uintptr_t) a
;
11258 uintptr_t ub
= (uintptr_t) b
;
11260 if (a
->number
< b
->number
)
11262 else if (a
->number
> b
->number
)
11265 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
11269 return ua
> ub
? 1 : 0;
11272 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
11275 clear_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
11277 struct breakpoint
*b
;
11280 std::vector
<symtab_and_line
> decoded_sals
;
11281 symtab_and_line last_sal
;
11282 gdb::array_view
<symtab_and_line
> sals
;
11286 = decode_line_with_current_source (arg
,
11287 (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
11288 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE
));
11290 sals
= decoded_sals
;
11294 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
11295 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
11296 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
11297 last_sal
= get_last_displayed_sal ();
11298 if (last_sal
.symtab
== 0)
11299 error (_("No source file specified."));
11305 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
11306 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
11307 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
11308 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
11310 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
11311 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
11312 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
11313 due to optimization, all in one block.
11315 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
11316 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
11317 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
11318 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
11319 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
11320 to support that. */
11322 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
11323 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
11324 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
11327 std::vector
<struct breakpoint
*> found
;
11328 for (const auto &sal
: sals
)
11330 const char *sal_fullname
;
11332 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
11333 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
11334 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
11337 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
11342 1 0 <can't happen> */
11344 sal_fullname
= (sal
.symtab
== NULL
11345 ? NULL
: symtab_to_fullname (sal
.symtab
));
11347 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
11348 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b
)
11351 /* Are we going to delete b? */
11352 if (b
->type
!= bp_none
&& !is_watchpoint (b
))
11354 struct bp_location
*loc
= b
->loc
;
11355 for (; loc
; loc
= loc
->next
)
11357 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
11358 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
11359 int pc_match
= (!sal
.explicit_line
11361 && (loc
->pspace
== sal
.pspace
)
11362 && (loc
->address
== sal
.pc
)
11363 && (!section_is_overlay (loc
->section
)
11364 || loc
->section
== sal
.section
));
11365 int line_match
= 0;
11367 if ((default_match
|| sal
.explicit_line
)
11368 && loc
->symtab
!= NULL
11369 && sal_fullname
!= NULL
11370 && sal
.pspace
== loc
->pspace
11371 && loc
->line_number
== sal
.line
11372 && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc
->symtab
),
11373 sal_fullname
) == 0)
11376 if (pc_match
|| line_match
)
11385 found
.push_back (b
);
11389 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
11390 if (found
.empty ())
11393 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg
);
11395 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
11398 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
11399 std::sort (found
.begin (), found
.end (),
11400 [] (const breakpoint
*bp_a
, const breakpoint
*bp_b
)
11402 return compare_breakpoints (bp_a
, bp_b
) < 0;
11404 found
.erase (std::unique (found
.begin (), found
.end (),
11405 [] (const breakpoint
*bp_a
, const breakpoint
*bp_b
)
11407 return compare_breakpoints (bp_a
, bp_b
) == 0;
11411 if (found
.size () > 1)
11412 from_tty
= 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
11415 if (found
.size () == 1)
11416 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
11418 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
11421 for (breakpoint
*iter
: found
)
11424 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", iter
->number
);
11425 delete_breakpoint (iter
);
11428 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
11431 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
11432 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
11433 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
11436 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs
)
11438 struct breakpoint
*b
, *b_tmp
;
11440 for (; bs
; bs
= bs
->next
)
11441 if (bs
->breakpoint_at
11442 && bs
->breakpoint_at
->disposition
== disp_del
11444 delete_breakpoint (bs
->breakpoint_at
);
11446 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, b_tmp
)
11448 if (b
->disposition
== disp_del_at_next_stop
)
11449 delete_breakpoint (b
);
11453 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
11454 std::sort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
11455 bl_address_is_meaningful says), secondarily by ordering first
11456 permanent elements and terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted
11457 stable way despite std::sort being an unstable algorithm. */
11460 bp_location_is_less_than (const bp_location
*a
, const bp_location
*b
)
11462 if (a
->address
!= b
->address
)
11463 return a
->address
< b
->address
;
11465 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
11466 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
11469 if (a
->pspace
->num
!= b
->pspace
->num
)
11470 return a
->pspace
->num
< b
->pspace
->num
;
11472 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
11473 if (a
->permanent
!= b
->permanent
)
11474 return a
->permanent
> b
->permanent
;
11476 /* Sort by type in order to make duplicate determination easier.
11477 See update_global_location_list. This is kept in sync with
11478 breakpoint_locations_match. */
11479 if (a
->loc_type
< b
->loc_type
)
11482 /* Likewise, for range-breakpoints, sort by length. */
11483 if (a
->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
11484 && b
->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
11485 && a
->length
< b
->length
)
11488 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
11489 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
11490 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
11492 if (a
->owner
->number
!= b
->owner
->number
)
11493 return a
->owner
->number
< b
->owner
->number
;
11498 /* Set bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max and
11499 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
11500 content of the bp_locations array. */
11503 bp_locations_target_extensions_update (void)
11505 struct bp_location
*bl
, **blp_tmp
;
11507 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
= 0;
11508 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
= 0;
11510 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl
, blp_tmp
)
11512 CORE_ADDR start
, end
, addr
;
11514 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl
))
11517 start
= bl
->target_info
.placed_address
;
11518 end
= start
+ bl
->target_info
.shadow_len
;
11520 gdb_assert (bl
->address
>= start
);
11521 addr
= bl
->address
- start
;
11522 if (addr
> bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
)
11523 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
= addr
;
11525 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
11527 gdb_assert (bl
->address
< end
);
11528 addr
= end
- bl
->address
;
11529 if (addr
> bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
)
11530 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
= addr
;
11534 /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
11537 download_tracepoint_locations (void)
11539 struct breakpoint
*b
;
11540 enum tribool can_download_tracepoint
= TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN
;
11542 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread
;
11544 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b
)
11546 struct bp_location
*bl
;
11547 struct tracepoint
*t
;
11548 int bp_location_downloaded
= 0;
11550 if ((b
->type
== bp_fast_tracepoint
11551 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
11552 : !may_insert_tracepoints
))
11555 if (can_download_tracepoint
== TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN
)
11557 if (target_can_download_tracepoint ())
11558 can_download_tracepoint
= TRIBOOL_TRUE
;
11560 can_download_tracepoint
= TRIBOOL_FALSE
;
11563 if (can_download_tracepoint
== TRIBOOL_FALSE
)
11566 for (bl
= b
->loc
; bl
; bl
= bl
->next
)
11568 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
11569 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
11570 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
11571 if (!should_be_inserted (bl
) || bl
->inserted
)
11574 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl
->pspace
);
11576 target_download_tracepoint (bl
);
11579 bp_location_downloaded
= 1;
11581 t
= (struct tracepoint
*) b
;
11582 t
->number_on_target
= b
->number
;
11583 if (bp_location_downloaded
)
11584 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified
.notify (b
);
11588 /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
11591 swap_insertion (struct bp_location
*left
, struct bp_location
*right
)
11593 const int left_inserted
= left
->inserted
;
11594 const int left_duplicate
= left
->duplicate
;
11595 const int left_needs_update
= left
->needs_update
;
11596 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info
= left
->target_info
;
11598 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
11599 if (is_tracepoint (left
->owner
))
11600 gdb_assert (!left
->duplicate
);
11601 if (is_tracepoint (right
->owner
))
11602 gdb_assert (!right
->duplicate
);
11604 left
->inserted
= right
->inserted
;
11605 left
->duplicate
= right
->duplicate
;
11606 left
->needs_update
= right
->needs_update
;
11607 left
->target_info
= right
->target_info
;
11608 right
->inserted
= left_inserted
;
11609 right
->duplicate
= left_duplicate
;
11610 right
->needs_update
= left_needs_update
;
11611 right
->target_info
= left_target_info
;
11614 /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
11615 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
11616 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
11620 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location
*bl
)
11622 struct bp_location
**locp
= NULL
, **loc2p
;
11623 struct bp_location
*loc
;
11624 CORE_ADDR address
= 0;
11627 address
= bl
->address
;
11628 pspace_num
= bl
->pspace
->num
;
11630 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
11631 evaluating conditions and if the user has
11632 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
11634 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
11635 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
11638 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
11639 the same program space as the location
11640 as "its condition has changed". We need to
11641 update the conditions on the target's side. */
11642 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p
, locp
, address
)
11646 if (!is_breakpoint (loc
->owner
)
11647 || pspace_num
!= loc
->pspace
->num
)
11650 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
11651 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
11652 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
11653 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
11654 that have already been marked. */
11655 loc
->condition_changed
= condition_updated
;
11657 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
11659 loc
->cond_bytecode
.reset ();
11663 /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints
11664 deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which
11665 locations are duplicate of which.
11667 The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or
11668 shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more
11672 update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode
)
11674 struct breakpoint
*b
;
11675 struct bp_location
**locp
, *loc
;
11676 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
11677 CORE_ADDR last_addr
= 0;
11678 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
11679 int last_pspace_num
= -1;
11681 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
11682 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
11683 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
11684 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
11685 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
11687 struct bp_location
*bp_loc_first
; /* breakpoint */
11688 struct bp_location
*wp_loc_first
; /* hardware watchpoint */
11689 struct bp_location
*awp_loc_first
; /* access watchpoint */
11690 struct bp_location
*rwp_loc_first
; /* read watchpoint */
11692 /* Saved former bp_locations array which we compare against the newly
11693 built bp_locations from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
11694 struct bp_location
**old_locp
;
11695 unsigned old_locations_count
;
11696 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<struct bp_location
*> old_locations (bp_locations
);
11698 old_locations_count
= bp_locations_count
;
11699 bp_locations
= NULL
;
11700 bp_locations_count
= 0;
11702 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b
)
11703 for (loc
= b
->loc
; loc
; loc
= loc
->next
)
11704 bp_locations_count
++;
11706 bp_locations
= XNEWVEC (struct bp_location
*, bp_locations_count
);
11707 locp
= bp_locations
;
11708 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b
)
11709 for (loc
= b
->loc
; loc
; loc
= loc
->next
)
11712 /* See if we need to "upgrade" a software breakpoint to a hardware
11713 breakpoint. Do this before deciding whether locations are
11714 duplicates. Also do this before sorting because sorting order
11715 depends on location type. */
11716 for (locp
= bp_locations
;
11717 locp
< bp_locations
+ bp_locations_count
;
11721 if (!loc
->inserted
&& should_be_inserted (loc
))
11722 handle_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (loc
);
11725 std::sort (bp_locations
, bp_locations
+ bp_locations_count
,
11726 bp_location_is_less_than
);
11728 bp_locations_target_extensions_update ();
11730 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
11731 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
11732 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
11733 if there's another location at the same address (previously
11734 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
11737 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
11738 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
11740 locp
= bp_locations
;
11741 for (old_locp
= old_locations
.get ();
11742 old_locp
< old_locations
.get () + old_locations_count
;
11745 struct bp_location
*old_loc
= *old_locp
;
11746 struct bp_location
**loc2p
;
11748 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
11749 not, we have to free it. */
11750 int found_object
= 0;
11751 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
11752 int keep_in_target
= 0;
11755 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
11756 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
11757 while (locp
< bp_locations
+ bp_locations_count
11758 && (*locp
)->address
< old_loc
->address
)
11762 (loc2p
< bp_locations
+ bp_locations_count
11763 && (*loc2p
)->address
== old_loc
->address
);
11766 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
11767 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
11768 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
11770 if ((*loc2p
)->condition_changed
== condition_modified
11771 && (last_addr
!= old_loc
->address
11772 || last_pspace_num
!= old_loc
->pspace
->num
))
11774 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (*loc2p
);
11775 last_pspace_num
= old_loc
->pspace
->num
;
11778 if (*loc2p
== old_loc
)
11782 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
11783 have to go through updates again. */
11784 last_addr
= old_loc
->address
;
11786 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
11788 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc
);
11790 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
11791 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
11792 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
11793 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
11794 at certain location is not inserted. */
11796 if (old_loc
->inserted
)
11798 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
11801 if (found_object
&& should_be_inserted (old_loc
))
11803 /* The location is still present in the location list,
11804 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
11805 keep_in_target
= 1;
11809 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
11810 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
11811 remove its target-side condition. */
11813 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
11814 disabled. See if there's another location at the
11815 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
11816 this one from the target. */
11818 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
11819 if (bl_address_is_meaningful (old_loc
))
11822 (loc2p
< bp_locations
+ bp_locations_count
11823 && (*loc2p
)->address
== old_loc
->address
);
11826 struct bp_location
*loc2
= *loc2p
;
11828 if (loc2
== old_loc
)
11831 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2
, old_loc
))
11833 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
11834 access watchpoints, if the former are not
11835 supported, but the latter are. */
11836 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc
->owner
))
11838 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2
->owner
));
11839 loc2
->watchpoint_type
= old_loc
->watchpoint_type
;
11842 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
11843 if it should be inserted in case it will be
11845 if (unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2
))
11847 swap_insertion (old_loc
, loc2
);
11848 keep_in_target
= 1;
11856 if (!keep_in_target
)
11858 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc
))
11860 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
11861 this location on the global list, and try to
11862 remove it next time, but there's no particular
11863 reason why we will succeed next time.
11865 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
11866 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
11867 only after calling us. */
11868 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
11869 "breakpoint %d\n"),
11870 old_loc
->owner
->number
);
11878 if (removed
&& target_is_non_stop_p ()
11879 && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc
))
11881 /* This location was removed from the target. In
11882 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
11883 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
11884 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
11885 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
11886 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
11887 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
11888 after we see some number of events. The theory here
11889 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
11890 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
11891 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
11892 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
11893 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
11894 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
11897 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
11898 decr_pc_after_break targets.
11900 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
11901 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
11902 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
11903 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
11904 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
11905 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
11906 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
11907 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
11908 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
11909 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
11910 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
11911 targets that do not support new thread events, like
11912 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
11915 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
11916 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
11917 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
11918 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
11920 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
11921 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
11922 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
11923 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
11924 traps we can no longer explain. */
11926 process_stratum_target
*proc_target
= nullptr;
11927 for (inferior
*inf
: all_inferiors ())
11928 if (inf
->pspace
== old_loc
->pspace
)
11930 proc_target
= inf
->process_target ();
11933 if (proc_target
!= nullptr)
11934 old_loc
->events_till_retirement
11935 = 3 * (thread_count (proc_target
) + 1);
11937 old_loc
->events_till_retirement
= 1;
11938 old_loc
->owner
= NULL
;
11940 moribund_locations
.push_back (old_loc
);
11944 old_loc
->owner
= NULL
;
11945 decref_bp_location (&old_loc
);
11950 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
11951 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
11952 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
11953 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
11954 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
11955 are sorted first for the same address.
11957 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
11958 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
11960 bp_loc_first
= NULL
;
11961 wp_loc_first
= NULL
;
11962 awp_loc_first
= NULL
;
11963 rwp_loc_first
= NULL
;
11964 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc
, locp
)
11966 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
11968 struct bp_location
**loc_first_p
;
11971 if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc
)
11972 || !bl_address_is_meaningful (loc
)
11973 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
11974 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
11975 `struct bp_location'. */
11976 || is_tracepoint (b
))
11978 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
11979 loc
->condition_changed
= condition_unchanged
;
11983 if (b
->type
== bp_hardware_watchpoint
)
11984 loc_first_p
= &wp_loc_first
;
11985 else if (b
->type
== bp_read_watchpoint
)
11986 loc_first_p
= &rwp_loc_first
;
11987 else if (b
->type
== bp_access_watchpoint
)
11988 loc_first_p
= &awp_loc_first
;
11990 loc_first_p
= &bp_loc_first
;
11992 if (*loc_first_p
== NULL
11993 || (overlay_debugging
&& loc
->section
!= (*loc_first_p
)->section
)
11994 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc
, *loc_first_p
))
11996 *loc_first_p
= loc
;
11997 loc
->duplicate
= 0;
11999 if (is_breakpoint (loc
->owner
) && loc
->condition_changed
)
12001 loc
->needs_update
= 1;
12002 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12003 loc
->condition_changed
= condition_unchanged
;
12009 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
12010 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
12011 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
12013 swap_insertion (loc
, *loc_first_p
);
12014 loc
->duplicate
= 1;
12016 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12017 loc
->condition_changed
= condition_unchanged
;
12020 if (insert_mode
== UGLL_INSERT
|| breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ())
12022 if (insert_mode
!= UGLL_DONT_INSERT
)
12023 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
12026 /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new
12027 locations, we may still need to update conditions on the
12028 target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted
12029 if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We
12030 only update conditions for locations that are marked
12032 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
12036 if (insert_mode
!= UGLL_DONT_INSERT
)
12037 download_tracepoint_locations ();
12041 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
12043 for (int ix
= 0; ix
< moribund_locations
.size (); ++ix
)
12045 struct bp_location
*loc
= moribund_locations
[ix
];
12046 if (--(loc
->events_till_retirement
) == 0)
12048 decref_bp_location (&loc
);
12049 unordered_remove (moribund_locations
, ix
);
12056 update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode
)
12061 update_global_location_list (insert_mode
);
12063 catch (const gdb_exception_error
&e
)
12068 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
12071 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps
, struct breakpoint
*bpt
)
12075 for (bs
= bps
; bs
; bs
= bs
->next
)
12076 if (bs
->breakpoint_at
== bpt
)
12078 bs
->breakpoint_at
= NULL
;
12079 bs
->old_val
= NULL
;
12080 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
12084 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
12086 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info
*th
, void *data
)
12088 struct breakpoint
*bpt
= (struct breakpoint
*) data
;
12090 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th
->control
.stop_bpstat
, bpt
);
12094 /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
12098 say_where (struct breakpoint
*b
)
12100 struct value_print_options opts
;
12102 get_user_print_options (&opts
);
12104 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
12106 if (b
->loc
== NULL
)
12108 /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based
12109 on b->extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either
12110 a condition or dprintf arguments. */
12111 if (b
->extra_string
== NULL
)
12113 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."),
12114 event_location_to_string (b
->location
.get ()));
12116 else if (b
->type
== bp_dprintf
)
12118 printf_filtered (_(" (%s,%s) pending."),
12119 event_location_to_string (b
->location
.get ()),
12124 printf_filtered (_(" (%s %s) pending."),
12125 event_location_to_string (b
->location
.get ()),
12131 if (opts
.addressprint
|| b
->loc
->symtab
== NULL
)
12132 printf_filtered (" at %ps",
12133 styled_string (address_style
.style (),
12134 paddress (b
->loc
->gdbarch
,
12135 b
->loc
->address
)));
12136 if (b
->loc
->symtab
!= NULL
)
12138 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
12140 if (b
->loc
->next
== NULL
)
12142 const char *filename
12143 = symtab_to_filename_for_display (b
->loc
->symtab
);
12144 printf_filtered (": file %ps, line %d.",
12145 styled_string (file_name_style
.style (),
12147 b
->loc
->line_number
);
12150 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
12151 different file name, and this at least reflects the
12152 real situation somewhat. */
12153 printf_filtered (": %s.",
12154 event_location_to_string (b
->location
.get ()));
12159 struct bp_location
*loc
= b
->loc
;
12161 for (; loc
; loc
= loc
->next
)
12163 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n
);
12168 bp_location::~bp_location ()
12170 xfree (function_name
);
12173 /* Destructor for the breakpoint base class. */
12175 breakpoint::~breakpoint ()
12177 xfree (this->cond_string
);
12178 xfree (this->extra_string
);
12181 static struct bp_location
*
12182 base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint
*self
)
12184 return new bp_location (self
);
12188 base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint
*b
)
12190 /* Nothing to re-set. */
12193 #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
12194 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
12197 base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location
*bl
)
12199 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12203 base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location
*bl
,
12204 enum remove_bp_reason reason
)
12206 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12210 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location
*bl
,
12211 const address_space
*aspace
,
12213 const struct target_waitstatus
*ws
)
12215 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12219 base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs
)
12224 /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12228 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint
*b
)
12230 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12233 /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12237 base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location
*bl
)
12239 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12242 static enum print_stop_action
12243 base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs
)
12245 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12249 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint
*self
,
12250 struct ui_out
*uiout
)
12256 base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint
*b
)
12258 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12262 base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct ui_file
*fp
)
12264 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12268 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location
12269 (struct event_location
*location
,
12270 struct linespec_result
*canonical
,
12271 enum bptype type_wanted
)
12273 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12277 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
12278 struct linespec_result
*c
,
12279 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> cond_string
,
12280 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> extra_string
,
12281 enum bptype type_wanted
,
12282 enum bpdisp disposition
,
12284 int task
, int ignore_count
,
12285 const struct breakpoint_ops
*o
,
12286 int from_tty
, int enabled
,
12287 int internal
, unsigned flags
)
12289 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12292 static std::vector
<symtab_and_line
>
12293 base_breakpoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint
*b
,
12294 struct event_location
*location
,
12295 struct program_space
*search_pspace
)
12297 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12300 /* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
12303 base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint
*b
, enum gdb_signal sig
)
12308 /* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
12311 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats
*bs
)
12313 /* Nothing to do. */
12316 struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops
=
12318 base_breakpoint_allocate_location
,
12319 base_breakpoint_re_set
,
12320 base_breakpoint_insert_location
,
12321 base_breakpoint_remove_location
,
12322 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit
,
12323 base_breakpoint_check_status
,
12324 base_breakpoint_resources_needed
,
12325 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode
,
12326 base_breakpoint_print_it
,
12328 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail
,
12329 base_breakpoint_print_mention
,
12330 base_breakpoint_print_recreate
,
12331 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location
,
12332 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal
,
12333 base_breakpoint_decode_location
,
12334 base_breakpoint_explains_signal
,
12335 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true
,
12338 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
12341 bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint
*b
)
12343 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
12344 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b
))
12346 /* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */
12347 delete_breakpoint (b
);
12351 breakpoint_re_set_default (b
);
12355 bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location
*bl
)
12357 CORE_ADDR addr
= bl
->target_info
.reqstd_address
;
12359 bl
->target_info
.kind
= breakpoint_kind (bl
, &addr
);
12360 bl
->target_info
.placed_address
= addr
;
12362 if (bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
)
12363 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl
->gdbarch
, &bl
->target_info
);
12365 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl
->gdbarch
, &bl
->target_info
);
12369 bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location
*bl
, enum remove_bp_reason reason
)
12371 if (bl
->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
)
12372 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl
->gdbarch
, &bl
->target_info
);
12374 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl
->gdbarch
, &bl
->target_info
, reason
);
12378 bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location
*bl
,
12379 const address_space
*aspace
, CORE_ADDR bp_addr
,
12380 const struct target_waitstatus
*ws
)
12382 if (ws
->kind
!= TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
12383 || ws
->value
.sig
!= GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP
)
12386 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl
->pspace
->aspace
, bl
->address
,
12390 if (overlay_debugging
/* unmapped overlay section */
12391 && section_is_overlay (bl
->section
)
12392 && !section_is_mapped (bl
->section
))
12399 dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location
*bl
,
12400 const address_space
*aspace
, CORE_ADDR bp_addr
,
12401 const struct target_waitstatus
*ws
)
12403 if (dprintf_style
== dprintf_style_agent
12404 && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
12406 /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
12407 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
12408 be set at the same address. */
12412 return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl
, aspace
, bp_addr
, ws
);
12416 bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location
*bl
)
12418 gdb_assert (bl
->owner
->type
== bp_hardware_breakpoint
);
12423 static enum print_stop_action
12424 bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs
)
12426 struct breakpoint
*b
;
12427 const struct bp_location
*bl
;
12429 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
12431 gdb_assert (bs
->bp_location_at
!= NULL
);
12433 bl
= bs
->bp_location_at
;
12434 b
= bs
->breakpoint_at
;
12436 bp_temp
= b
->disposition
== disp_del
;
12437 if (bl
->address
!= bl
->requested_address
)
12438 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl
->requested_address
,
12441 annotate_breakpoint (b
->number
);
12442 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout
);
12444 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
12446 uiout
->field_string ("reason",
12447 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT
));
12448 uiout
->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b
->disposition
));
12451 uiout
->message ("Temporary breakpoint %pF, ",
12452 signed_field ("bkptno", b
->number
));
12454 uiout
->message ("Breakpoint %pF, ",
12455 signed_field ("bkptno", b
->number
));
12457 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
;
12461 bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint
*b
)
12463 if (current_uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
12468 case bp_breakpoint
:
12469 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver
:
12470 if (b
->disposition
== disp_del
)
12471 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
12473 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
12474 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b
->number
);
12475 if (b
->type
== bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver
)
12476 printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
12478 case bp_hardware_breakpoint
:
12479 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b
->number
);
12482 printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b
->number
);
12490 bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint
*tp
, struct ui_file
*fp
)
12492 if (tp
->type
== bp_breakpoint
&& tp
->disposition
== disp_del
)
12493 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "tbreak");
12494 else if (tp
->type
== bp_breakpoint
)
12495 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "break");
12496 else if (tp
->type
== bp_hardware_breakpoint
12497 && tp
->disposition
== disp_del
)
12498 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "thbreak");
12499 else if (tp
->type
== bp_hardware_breakpoint
)
12500 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "hbreak");
12502 internal_error (__FILE__
, __LINE__
,
12503 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp
->type
);
12505 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, " %s",
12506 event_location_to_string (tp
->location
.get ()));
12508 /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might
12509 contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */
12510 if (tp
->loc
== NULL
&& tp
->extra_string
!= NULL
)
12511 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, " %s", tp
->extra_string
);
12513 print_recreate_thread (tp
, fp
);
12517 bkpt_create_sals_from_location (struct event_location
*location
,
12518 struct linespec_result
*canonical
,
12519 enum bptype type_wanted
)
12521 create_sals_from_location_default (location
, canonical
, type_wanted
);
12525 bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
12526 struct linespec_result
*canonical
,
12527 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> cond_string
,
12528 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> extra_string
,
12529 enum bptype type_wanted
,
12530 enum bpdisp disposition
,
12532 int task
, int ignore_count
,
12533 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
,
12534 int from_tty
, int enabled
,
12535 int internal
, unsigned flags
)
12537 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch
, canonical
,
12538 std::move (cond_string
),
12539 std::move (extra_string
),
12541 disposition
, thread
, task
,
12542 ignore_count
, ops
, from_tty
,
12543 enabled
, internal
, flags
);
12546 static std::vector
<symtab_and_line
>
12547 bkpt_decode_location (struct breakpoint
*b
,
12548 struct event_location
*location
,
12549 struct program_space
*search_pspace
)
12551 return decode_location_default (b
, location
, search_pspace
);
12554 /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
12557 internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint
*b
)
12561 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
12562 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
12563 case bp_overlay_event
:
12564 case bp_longjmp_master
:
12565 case bp_std_terminate_master
:
12566 case bp_exception_master
:
12567 delete_breakpoint (b
);
12570 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
12571 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
12572 case bp_shlib_event
:
12574 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
12575 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
12576 case bp_thread_event
:
12582 internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs
)
12584 if (bs
->breakpoint_at
->type
== bp_shlib_event
)
12586 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
12587 events. This allows the user to get control and place
12588 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
12589 objects (among other things). */
12590 bs
->stop
= stop_on_solib_events
;
12591 bs
->print
= stop_on_solib_events
;
12597 static enum print_stop_action
12598 internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs
)
12600 struct breakpoint
*b
;
12602 b
= bs
->breakpoint_at
;
12606 case bp_shlib_event
:
12607 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
12608 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
12609 to shlib event" message.) */
12610 print_solib_event (0);
12613 case bp_thread_event
:
12614 /* Not sure how we will get here.
12615 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
12616 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12619 case bp_overlay_event
:
12620 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
12621 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12624 case bp_longjmp_master
:
12625 /* These should never be enabled. */
12626 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12629 case bp_std_terminate_master
:
12630 /* These should never be enabled. */
12631 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
12632 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12635 case bp_exception_master
:
12636 /* These should never be enabled. */
12637 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
12638 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12642 return PRINT_NOTHING
;
12646 internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint
*b
)
12648 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12651 /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
12654 momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint
*b
)
12656 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
12657 over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
12658 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
12659 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
12663 momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs
)
12665 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
12668 static enum print_stop_action
12669 momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs
)
12671 return PRINT_UNKNOWN
;
12675 momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint
*b
)
12677 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12680 /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
12682 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
12683 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
12685 longjmp_breakpoint::~longjmp_breakpoint ()
12687 thread_info
*tp
= find_thread_global_id (this->thread
);
12690 tp
->initiating_frame
= null_frame_id
;
12693 /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
12696 bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location
*bl
)
12698 int v
= bkpt_insert_location (bl
);
12702 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
12704 bl
->probe
.prob
->set_semaphore (bl
->probe
.objfile
, bl
->gdbarch
);
12711 bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location
*bl
,
12712 enum remove_bp_reason reason
)
12714 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
12715 bl
->probe
.prob
->clear_semaphore (bl
->probe
.objfile
, bl
->gdbarch
);
12717 return bkpt_remove_location (bl
, reason
);
12721 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (struct event_location
*location
,
12722 struct linespec_result
*canonical
,
12723 enum bptype type_wanted
)
12725 struct linespec_sals lsal
;
12727 lsal
.sals
= parse_probes (location
, NULL
, canonical
);
12729 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical
->location
.get ()));
12730 canonical
->lsals
.push_back (std::move (lsal
));
12733 static std::vector
<symtab_and_line
>
12734 bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint
*b
,
12735 struct event_location
*location
,
12736 struct program_space
*search_pspace
)
12738 std::vector
<symtab_and_line
> sals
= parse_probes (location
, search_pspace
, NULL
);
12740 error (_("probe not found"));
12744 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
12747 tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint
*b
)
12749 breakpoint_re_set_default (b
);
12753 tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location
*bl
,
12754 const address_space
*aspace
, CORE_ADDR bp_addr
,
12755 const struct target_waitstatus
*ws
)
12757 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
12763 tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint
*self
,
12764 struct ui_out
*uiout
)
12766 struct tracepoint
*tp
= (struct tracepoint
*) self
;
12767 if (!tp
->static_trace_marker_id
.empty ())
12769 gdb_assert (self
->type
== bp_static_tracepoint
);
12771 uiout
->message ("\tmarker id is %pF\n",
12772 string_field ("static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
12773 tp
->static_trace_marker_id
.c_str ()));
12778 tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint
*b
)
12780 if (current_uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
12785 case bp_tracepoint
:
12786 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
12787 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b
->number
);
12789 case bp_fast_tracepoint
:
12790 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
12791 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b
->number
);
12793 case bp_static_tracepoint
:
12794 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
12795 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b
->number
);
12798 internal_error (__FILE__
, __LINE__
,
12799 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b
->type
);
12806 tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint
*self
, struct ui_file
*fp
)
12808 struct tracepoint
*tp
= (struct tracepoint
*) self
;
12810 if (self
->type
== bp_fast_tracepoint
)
12811 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "ftrace");
12812 else if (self
->type
== bp_static_tracepoint
)
12813 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "strace");
12814 else if (self
->type
== bp_tracepoint
)
12815 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "trace");
12817 internal_error (__FILE__
, __LINE__
,
12818 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self
->type
);
12820 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, " %s",
12821 event_location_to_string (self
->location
.get ()));
12822 print_recreate_thread (self
, fp
);
12824 if (tp
->pass_count
)
12825 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, " passcount %d\n", tp
->pass_count
);
12829 tracepoint_create_sals_from_location (struct event_location
*location
,
12830 struct linespec_result
*canonical
,
12831 enum bptype type_wanted
)
12833 create_sals_from_location_default (location
, canonical
, type_wanted
);
12837 tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
12838 struct linespec_result
*canonical
,
12839 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> cond_string
,
12840 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> extra_string
,
12841 enum bptype type_wanted
,
12842 enum bpdisp disposition
,
12844 int task
, int ignore_count
,
12845 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
,
12846 int from_tty
, int enabled
,
12847 int internal
, unsigned flags
)
12849 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch
, canonical
,
12850 std::move (cond_string
),
12851 std::move (extra_string
),
12853 disposition
, thread
, task
,
12854 ignore_count
, ops
, from_tty
,
12855 enabled
, internal
, flags
);
12858 static std::vector
<symtab_and_line
>
12859 tracepoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint
*b
,
12860 struct event_location
*location
,
12861 struct program_space
*search_pspace
)
12863 return decode_location_default (b
, location
, search_pspace
);
12866 struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops
;
12868 /* Virtual table for tracepoints on static probes. */
12871 tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location
12872 (struct event_location
*location
,
12873 struct linespec_result
*canonical
,
12874 enum bptype type_wanted
)
12876 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12877 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location
, canonical
, type_wanted
);
12880 static std::vector
<symtab_and_line
>
12881 tracepoint_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint
*b
,
12882 struct event_location
*location
,
12883 struct program_space
*search_pspace
)
12885 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12886 return bkpt_probe_decode_location (b
, location
, search_pspace
);
12889 /* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
12892 dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint
*b
)
12894 breakpoint_re_set_default (b
);
12896 /* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf. */
12897 gdb_assert (b
->extra_string
!= NULL
);
12899 /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
12900 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
12901 3 - disconnect from target 1
12902 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
12904 After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
12905 be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
12906 answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
12907 Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
12908 it all the time. */
12909 if (b
->extra_string
!= NULL
)
12910 update_dprintf_command_list (b
);
12913 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
12916 dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint
*tp
, struct ui_file
*fp
)
12918 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "dprintf %s,%s",
12919 event_location_to_string (tp
->location
.get ()),
12921 print_recreate_thread (tp
, fp
);
12924 /* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
12927 dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
12928 list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
12929 stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
12930 also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
12931 address are all handled. */
12934 dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats
*bs
)
12936 struct bpstats tmp_bs
;
12937 struct bpstats
*tmp_bs_p
= &tmp_bs
;
12939 /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
12940 check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
12941 condition not be evaluated. */
12944 /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
12945 copying. We never want these commands to run later in
12946 bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
12947 be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
12948 commands here throws. */
12949 tmp_bs
.commands
= bs
->commands
;
12950 bs
->commands
= NULL
;
12952 bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p
);
12954 /* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but
12955 bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole
12959 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
12963 strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (struct event_location
*location
,
12964 struct linespec_result
*canonical
,
12965 enum bptype type_wanted
)
12967 struct linespec_sals lsal
;
12968 const char *arg_start
, *arg
;
12970 arg
= arg_start
= get_linespec_location (location
)->spec_string
;
12971 lsal
.sals
= decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg
);
12973 std::string
str (arg_start
, arg
- arg_start
);
12974 const char *ptr
= str
.c_str ();
12975 canonical
->location
12976 = new_linespec_location (&ptr
, symbol_name_match_type::FULL
);
12979 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical
->location
.get ()));
12980 canonical
->lsals
.push_back (std::move (lsal
));
12984 strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
12985 struct linespec_result
*canonical
,
12986 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> cond_string
,
12987 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> extra_string
,
12988 enum bptype type_wanted
,
12989 enum bpdisp disposition
,
12991 int task
, int ignore_count
,
12992 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
,
12993 int from_tty
, int enabled
,
12994 int internal
, unsigned flags
)
12996 const linespec_sals
&lsal
= canonical
->lsals
[0];
12998 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
12999 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
13000 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
13001 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
13002 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
13003 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
13005 for (size_t i
= 0; i
< lsal
.sals
.size (); i
++)
13007 event_location_up location
13008 = copy_event_location (canonical
->location
.get ());
13010 std::unique_ptr
<tracepoint
> tp (new tracepoint ());
13011 init_breakpoint_sal (tp
.get (), gdbarch
, lsal
.sals
[i
],
13012 std::move (location
), NULL
,
13013 std::move (cond_string
),
13014 std::move (extra_string
),
13015 type_wanted
, disposition
,
13016 thread
, task
, ignore_count
, ops
,
13017 from_tty
, enabled
, internal
, flags
,
13018 canonical
->special_display
);
13019 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
13020 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
13021 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
13022 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
13023 try to match up which of the newly found markers
13024 corresponds to this one */
13025 tp
->static_trace_marker_id_idx
= i
;
13027 install_breakpoint (internal
, std::move (tp
), 0);
13031 static std::vector
<symtab_and_line
>
13032 strace_marker_decode_location (struct breakpoint
*b
,
13033 struct event_location
*location
,
13034 struct program_space
*search_pspace
)
13036 struct tracepoint
*tp
= (struct tracepoint
*) b
;
13037 const char *s
= get_linespec_location (location
)->spec_string
;
13039 std::vector
<symtab_and_line
> sals
= decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s
);
13040 if (sals
.size () > tp
->static_trace_marker_id_idx
)
13042 sals
[0] = sals
[tp
->static_trace_marker_id_idx
];
13047 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp
->static_trace_marker_id
.c_str ());
13050 static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops
;
13053 strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint
*b
)
13055 return b
->ops
== &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops
;
13058 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
13062 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint
*bpt
)
13064 struct breakpoint
*b
;
13066 gdb_assert (bpt
!= NULL
);
13068 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
13069 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
13072 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
13073 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
13074 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
13075 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
13076 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
13079 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
13080 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
13081 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
13082 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
13084 if (bpt
->type
== bp_none
)
13087 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
13088 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
13089 if (bpt
->related_breakpoint
!= bpt
)
13091 struct breakpoint
*related
;
13092 struct watchpoint
*w
;
13094 if (bpt
->type
== bp_watchpoint_scope
)
13095 w
= (struct watchpoint
*) bpt
->related_breakpoint
;
13096 else if (bpt
->related_breakpoint
->type
== bp_watchpoint_scope
)
13097 w
= (struct watchpoint
*) bpt
;
13101 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w
);
13103 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
13104 for (related
= bpt
; related
->related_breakpoint
!= bpt
;
13105 related
= related
->related_breakpoint
);
13106 related
->related_breakpoint
= bpt
->related_breakpoint
;
13107 bpt
->related_breakpoint
= bpt
;
13110 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
13111 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
13112 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
13113 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
13115 gdb::observers::breakpoint_deleted
.notify (bpt
);
13117 if (breakpoint_chain
== bpt
)
13118 breakpoint_chain
= bpt
->next
;
13120 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b
)
13121 if (b
->next
== bpt
)
13123 b
->next
= bpt
->next
;
13127 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
13129 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
13130 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
13131 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
13132 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
13133 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
13134 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
13135 commands won't work. */
13137 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback
, bpt
);
13139 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
13140 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
13141 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
13142 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
13143 might be better design to have location completely
13144 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
13145 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT
);
13147 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
13148 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
13149 bpt
->type
= bp_none
;
13153 /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
13154 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
13157 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint
*b
,
13158 gdb::function_view
<void (breakpoint
*)> function
)
13160 struct breakpoint
*related
;
13165 struct breakpoint
*next
;
13167 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
13168 next
= related
->related_breakpoint
;
13170 if (next
== related
)
13172 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
13173 function (related
);
13175 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
13176 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
13181 function (related
);
13185 while (related
!= b
);
13189 delete_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
13191 struct breakpoint
*b
, *b_tmp
;
13197 int breaks_to_delete
= 0;
13199 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
13200 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
13201 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
13202 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b
)
13203 if (user_breakpoint_p (b
))
13205 breaks_to_delete
= 1;
13209 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
13211 || (breaks_to_delete
&& query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
13213 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, b_tmp
)
13214 if (user_breakpoint_p (b
))
13215 delete_breakpoint (b
);
13219 map_breakpoint_numbers
13220 (arg
, [&] (breakpoint
*br
)
13222 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br
, delete_breakpoint
);
13226 /* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending. If
13227 PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are
13231 all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct program_space
*pspace
)
13233 struct bp_location
*loc
;
13235 for (loc
= b
->loc
; loc
!= NULL
; loc
= loc
->next
)
13236 if ((pspace
== NULL
13237 || loc
->pspace
== pspace
)
13238 && !loc
->shlib_disabled
13239 && !loc
->pspace
->executing_startup
)
13244 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
13245 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
13246 Null names are ignored. */
13249 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location
*loc
)
13251 struct bp_location
*l
;
13252 htab_t htab
= htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string
, streq_hash
, NULL
,
13255 for (l
= loc
; l
!= NULL
; l
= l
->next
)
13258 const char *name
= l
->function_name
;
13260 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
13264 slot
= (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab
, (const void *) name
,
13266 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
13270 htab_delete (htab
);
13276 htab_delete (htab
);
13280 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
13281 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
13282 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
13283 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
13284 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
13285 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
13286 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
13287 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
13290 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
13291 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
13292 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
13293 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
13294 in the sources, and output a warning.
13296 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
13297 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
13298 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
13299 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
13300 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
13303 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
13304 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
13305 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
13306 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
13307 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
13308 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
13309 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
13310 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
13311 precisely because it confuses tools). */
13313 static struct symtab_and_line
13314 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct symtab_and_line sal
)
13316 struct tracepoint
*tp
= (struct tracepoint
*) b
;
13317 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker
;
13322 find_line_pc (sal
.symtab
, sal
.line
, &pc
);
13324 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc
, &marker
))
13326 if (tp
->static_trace_marker_id
!= marker
.str_id
)
13327 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
13328 b
->number
, tp
->static_trace_marker_id
.c_str (),
13329 marker
.str_id
.c_str ());
13331 tp
->static_trace_marker_id
= std::move (marker
.str_id
);
13336 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
13338 if (!sal
.explicit_pc
13340 && sal
.symtab
!= NULL
13341 && !tp
->static_trace_marker_id
.empty ())
13343 std::vector
<static_tracepoint_marker
> markers
13344 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid
13345 (tp
->static_trace_marker_id
.c_str ());
13347 if (!markers
.empty ())
13349 struct symbol
*sym
;
13350 struct static_tracepoint_marker
*tpmarker
;
13351 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
13352 struct explicit_location explicit_loc
;
13354 tpmarker
= &markers
[0];
13356 tp
->static_trace_marker_id
= std::move (tpmarker
->str_id
);
13358 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
13359 "found at previous line number"),
13360 b
->number
, tp
->static_trace_marker_id
.c_str ());
13362 symtab_and_line sal2
= find_pc_line (tpmarker
->address
, 0);
13363 sym
= find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker
->address
, NULL
);
13364 uiout
->text ("Now in ");
13367 uiout
->field_string ("func", sym
->print_name (),
13368 function_name_style
.style ());
13369 uiout
->text (" at ");
13371 uiout
->field_string ("file",
13372 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2
.symtab
),
13373 file_name_style
.style ());
13376 if (uiout
->is_mi_like_p ())
13378 const char *fullname
= symtab_to_fullname (sal2
.symtab
);
13380 uiout
->field_string ("fullname", fullname
);
13383 uiout
->field_signed ("line", sal2
.line
);
13384 uiout
->text ("\n");
13386 b
->loc
->line_number
= sal2
.line
;
13387 b
->loc
->symtab
= sym
!= NULL
? sal2
.symtab
: NULL
;
13389 b
->location
.reset (NULL
);
13390 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc
);
13391 explicit_loc
.source_filename
13392 = ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2
.symtab
));
13393 explicit_loc
.line_offset
.offset
= b
->loc
->line_number
;
13394 explicit_loc
.line_offset
.sign
= LINE_OFFSET_NONE
;
13395 b
->location
= new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc
);
13397 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
13404 /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
13405 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
13408 locations_are_equal (struct bp_location
*a
, struct bp_location
*b
)
13412 if (a
->address
!= b
->address
)
13415 if (a
->shlib_disabled
!= b
->shlib_disabled
)
13418 if (a
->enabled
!= b
->enabled
)
13425 if ((a
== NULL
) != (b
== NULL
))
13431 /* Split all locations of B that are bound to PSPACE out of B's
13432 location list to a separate list and return that list's head. If
13433 PSPACE is NULL, hoist out all locations of B. */
13435 static struct bp_location
*
13436 hoist_existing_locations (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct program_space
*pspace
)
13438 struct bp_location head
;
13439 struct bp_location
*i
= b
->loc
;
13440 struct bp_location
**i_link
= &b
->loc
;
13441 struct bp_location
*hoisted
= &head
;
13443 if (pspace
== NULL
)
13454 if (i
->pspace
== pspace
)
13469 /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software
13470 breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not
13471 zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint. Only recreates locations for
13472 FILTER_PSPACE. Locations of other program spaces are left
13476 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint
*b
,
13477 struct program_space
*filter_pspace
,
13478 gdb::array_view
<const symtab_and_line
> sals
,
13479 gdb::array_view
<const symtab_and_line
> sals_end
)
13481 struct bp_location
*existing_locations
;
13483 if (!sals_end
.empty () && (sals
.size () != 1 || sals_end
.size () != 1))
13485 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
13487 b
->enable_state
= bp_disabled
;
13488 printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
13489 "multiple locations found\n"),
13494 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
13495 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
13496 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
13497 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
13498 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
13499 individual locations. */
13500 if (all_locations_are_pending (b
, filter_pspace
) && sals
.empty ())
13503 existing_locations
= hoist_existing_locations (b
, filter_pspace
);
13505 for (const auto &sal
: sals
)
13507 struct bp_location
*new_loc
;
13509 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal
.pspace
);
13511 new_loc
= add_location_to_breakpoint (b
, &sal
);
13513 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
13515 if (b
->cond_string
!= NULL
)
13519 s
= b
->cond_string
;
13522 new_loc
->cond
= parse_exp_1 (&s
, sal
.pc
,
13523 block_for_pc (sal
.pc
),
13526 catch (const gdb_exception_error
&e
)
13528 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition "
13529 "for breakpoint %d: %s"),
13530 b
->number
, e
.what ());
13531 new_loc
->enabled
= 0;
13535 if (!sals_end
.empty ())
13537 CORE_ADDR end
= find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end
[0]);
13539 new_loc
->length
= end
- sals
[0].pc
+ 1;
13543 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
13546 struct bp_location
*e
= existing_locations
;
13547 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
13548 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
13549 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
13550 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
13551 often enough until a better solution is found. */
13552 int have_ambiguous_names
= ambiguous_names_p (b
->loc
);
13554 for (; e
; e
= e
->next
)
13556 if (!e
->enabled
&& e
->function_name
)
13558 struct bp_location
*l
= b
->loc
;
13559 if (have_ambiguous_names
)
13561 for (; l
; l
= l
->next
)
13563 /* Ignore software vs hardware location type at
13564 this point, because with "set breakpoint
13565 auto-hw", after a re-set, locations that were
13566 hardware can end up as software, or vice versa.
13567 As mentioned above, this is an heuristic and in
13568 practice should give the correct answer often
13570 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e
, l
, true))
13579 for (; l
; l
= l
->next
)
13580 if (l
->function_name
13581 && strcmp (e
->function_name
, l
->function_name
) == 0)
13591 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations
, b
->loc
))
13592 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified
.notify (b
);
13595 /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION.
13596 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
13598 static std::vector
<symtab_and_line
>
13599 location_to_sals (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct event_location
*location
,
13600 struct program_space
*search_pspace
, int *found
)
13602 struct gdb_exception exception
;
13604 gdb_assert (b
->ops
!= NULL
);
13606 std::vector
<symtab_and_line
> sals
;
13610 sals
= b
->ops
->decode_location (b
, location
, search_pspace
);
13612 catch (gdb_exception_error
&e
)
13614 int not_found_and_ok
= 0;
13616 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
13617 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
13618 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
13619 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
13620 state, then user already saw the message about that
13621 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
13623 if (e
.error
== NOT_FOUND_ERROR
13624 && (b
->condition_not_parsed
13626 && search_pspace
!= NULL
13627 && b
->loc
->pspace
!= search_pspace
)
13628 || (b
->loc
&& b
->loc
->shlib_disabled
)
13629 || (b
->loc
&& b
->loc
->pspace
->executing_startup
)
13630 || b
->enable_state
== bp_disabled
))
13631 not_found_and_ok
= 1;
13633 if (!not_found_and_ok
)
13635 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
13636 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
13637 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
13638 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
13639 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
13640 which approach is better. */
13641 b
->enable_state
= bp_disabled
;
13645 exception
= std::move (e
);
13648 if (exception
.reason
== 0 || exception
.error
!= NOT_FOUND_ERROR
)
13650 for (auto &sal
: sals
)
13651 resolve_sal_pc (&sal
);
13652 if (b
->condition_not_parsed
&& b
->extra_string
!= NULL
)
13654 char *cond_string
, *extra_string
;
13657 find_condition_and_thread (b
->extra_string
, sals
[0].pc
,
13658 &cond_string
, &thread
, &task
,
13660 gdb_assert (b
->cond_string
== NULL
);
13662 b
->cond_string
= cond_string
;
13663 b
->thread
= thread
;
13667 xfree (b
->extra_string
);
13668 b
->extra_string
= extra_string
;
13670 b
->condition_not_parsed
= 0;
13673 if (b
->type
== bp_static_tracepoint
&& !strace_marker_p (b
))
13674 sals
[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b
, sals
[0]);
13684 /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
13685 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
13689 breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint
*b
)
13691 struct program_space
*filter_pspace
= current_program_space
;
13692 std::vector
<symtab_and_line
> expanded
, expanded_end
;
13695 std::vector
<symtab_and_line
> sals
= location_to_sals (b
, b
->location
.get (),
13696 filter_pspace
, &found
);
13698 expanded
= std::move (sals
);
13700 if (b
->location_range_end
!= NULL
)
13702 std::vector
<symtab_and_line
> sals_end
13703 = location_to_sals (b
, b
->location_range_end
.get (),
13704 filter_pspace
, &found
);
13706 expanded_end
= std::move (sals_end
);
13709 update_breakpoint_locations (b
, filter_pspace
, expanded
, expanded_end
);
13712 /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
13713 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
13716 create_sals_from_location_default (struct event_location
*location
,
13717 struct linespec_result
*canonical
,
13718 enum bptype type_wanted
)
13720 parse_breakpoint_sals (location
, canonical
);
13723 /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
13724 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
13728 create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
13729 struct linespec_result
*canonical
,
13730 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> cond_string
,
13731 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> extra_string
,
13732 enum bptype type_wanted
,
13733 enum bpdisp disposition
,
13735 int task
, int ignore_count
,
13736 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
,
13737 int from_tty
, int enabled
,
13738 int internal
, unsigned flags
)
13740 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch
, canonical
,
13741 std::move (cond_string
),
13742 std::move (extra_string
),
13743 type_wanted
, disposition
,
13744 thread
, task
, ignore_count
, ops
, from_tty
,
13745 enabled
, internal
, flags
);
13748 /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
13749 default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops. */
13751 static std::vector
<symtab_and_line
>
13752 decode_location_default (struct breakpoint
*b
,
13753 struct event_location
*location
,
13754 struct program_space
*search_pspace
)
13756 struct linespec_result canonical
;
13758 decode_line_full (location
, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
, search_pspace
,
13759 NULL
, 0, &canonical
, multiple_symbols_all
,
13762 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
13763 gdb_assert (canonical
.lsals
.size () < 2);
13765 if (!canonical
.lsals
.empty ())
13767 const linespec_sals
&lsal
= canonical
.lsals
[0];
13768 return std::move (lsal
.sals
);
13773 /* Reset a breakpoint. */
13776 breakpoint_re_set_one (breakpoint
*b
)
13778 input_radix
= b
->input_radix
;
13779 set_language (b
->language
);
13781 b
->ops
->re_set (b
);
13784 /* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space.
13785 Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched. */
13788 breakpoint_re_set (void)
13790 struct breakpoint
*b
, *b_tmp
;
13793 scoped_restore_current_language save_language
;
13794 scoped_restore save_input_radix
= make_scoped_restore (&input_radix
);
13795 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread
;
13797 /* breakpoint_re_set_one sets the current_language to the language
13798 of the breakpoint it is resetting (see prepare_re_set_context)
13799 before re-evaluating the breakpoint's location. This change can
13800 unfortunately get undone by accident if the language_mode is set
13801 to auto, and we either switch frames, or more likely in this context,
13802 we select the current frame.
13804 We prevent this by temporarily turning the language_mode to
13805 language_mode_manual. We restore it once all breakpoints
13806 have been reset. */
13807 scoped_restore save_language_mode
= make_scoped_restore (&language_mode
);
13808 language_mode
= language_mode_manual
;
13810 /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all
13811 breakpoints have been re-set. Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting
13812 breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which
13813 hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations. */
13815 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, b_tmp
)
13819 breakpoint_re_set_one (b
);
13821 catch (const gdb_exception
&ex
)
13823 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr
, ex
,
13824 "Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
13829 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
13832 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
13833 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
13834 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
13835 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
13837 /* Now we can insert. */
13838 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT
);
13841 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
13843 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
13844 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
13846 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint
*b
)
13848 if (b
->thread
!= -1)
13850 b
->thread
= inferior_thread ()->global_num
;
13852 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
13853 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
13854 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
13856 b
->loc
->pspace
= current_program_space
;
13860 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
13861 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
13862 which ends with a period (no newline). */
13865 set_ignore_count (int bptnum
, int count
, int from_tty
)
13867 struct breakpoint
*b
;
13872 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b
)
13873 if (b
->number
== bptnum
)
13875 if (is_tracepoint (b
))
13877 if (from_tty
&& count
!= 0)
13878 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
13883 b
->ignore_count
= count
;
13887 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
13888 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
13890 else if (count
== 1)
13891 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
13894 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
13895 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
13898 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified
.notify (b
);
13902 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum
);
13905 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
13908 ignore_command (const char *args
, int from_tty
)
13910 const char *p
= args
;
13914 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
13916 num
= get_number (&p
);
13918 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args
);
13920 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
13922 set_ignore_count (num
,
13923 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p
))),
13926 printf_filtered ("\n");
13930 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints with numbers in the range
13931 defined by BP_NUM_RANGE (an inclusive range). */
13934 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::pair
<int, int> bp_num_range
,
13935 gdb::function_view
<void (breakpoint
*)> function
)
13937 if (bp_num_range
.first
== 0)
13939 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%d'"),
13940 bp_num_range
.first
);
13944 struct breakpoint
*b
, *tmp
;
13946 for (int i
= bp_num_range
.first
; i
<= bp_num_range
.second
; i
++)
13948 bool match
= false;
13950 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, tmp
)
13951 if (b
->number
== i
)
13958 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), i
);
13963 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints whose numbers are given in
13967 map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *args
,
13968 gdb::function_view
<void (breakpoint
*)> function
)
13970 if (args
== NULL
|| *args
== '\0')
13971 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
13973 number_or_range_parser
parser (args
);
13975 while (!parser
.finished ())
13977 int num
= parser
.get_number ();
13978 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::make_pair (num
, num
), function
);
13982 /* Return the breakpoint location structure corresponding to the
13983 BP_NUM and LOC_NUM values. */
13985 static struct bp_location
*
13986 find_location_by_number (int bp_num
, int loc_num
)
13988 struct breakpoint
*b
;
13990 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b
)
13991 if (b
->number
== bp_num
)
13996 if (!b
|| b
->number
!= bp_num
)
13997 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%d'"), bp_num
);
14000 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num
);
14003 for (bp_location
*loc
= b
->loc
; loc
!= NULL
; loc
= loc
->next
)
14004 if (++n
== loc_num
)
14007 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num
);
14010 /* Modes of operation for extract_bp_num. */
14011 enum class extract_bp_kind
14013 /* Extracting a breakpoint number. */
14016 /* Extracting a location number. */
14020 /* Extract a breakpoint or location number (as determined by KIND)
14021 from the string starting at START. TRAILER is a character which
14022 can be found after the number. If you don't want a trailer, use
14023 '\0'. If END_OUT is not NULL, it is set to point after the parsed
14024 string. This always returns a positive integer. */
14027 extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind kind
, const char *start
,
14028 int trailer
, const char **end_out
= NULL
)
14030 const char *end
= start
;
14031 int num
= get_number_trailer (&end
, trailer
);
14033 error (kind
== extract_bp_kind::bp
14034 ? _("Negative breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14035 : _("Negative breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14036 int (end
- start
), start
);
14038 error (kind
== extract_bp_kind::bp
14039 ? _("Bad breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14040 : _("Bad breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14041 int (end
- start
), start
);
14043 if (end_out
!= NULL
)
14048 /* Extract a breakpoint or location range (as determined by KIND) in
14049 the form NUM1-NUM2 stored at &ARG[arg_offset]. Returns a std::pair
14050 representing the (inclusive) range. The returned pair's elements
14051 are always positive integers. */
14053 static std::pair
<int, int>
14054 extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind kind
,
14055 const std::string
&arg
,
14056 std::string::size_type arg_offset
)
14058 std::pair
<int, int> range
;
14059 const char *bp_loc
= &arg
[arg_offset
];
14060 std::string::size_type dash
= arg
.find ('-', arg_offset
);
14061 if (dash
!= std::string::npos
)
14063 /* bp_loc is a range (x-z). */
14064 if (arg
.length () == dash
+ 1)
14065 error (kind
== extract_bp_kind::bp
14066 ? _("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'")
14067 : _("Bad breakpoint location number at or near: '%s'"),
14071 const char *start_first
= bp_loc
;
14072 const char *start_second
= &arg
[dash
+ 1];
14073 range
.first
= extract_bp_num (kind
, start_first
, '-');
14074 range
.second
= extract_bp_num (kind
, start_second
, '\0', &end
);
14076 if (range
.first
> range
.second
)
14077 error (kind
== extract_bp_kind::bp
14078 ? _("Inverted breakpoint range at '%.*s'")
14079 : _("Inverted breakpoint location range at '%.*s'"),
14080 int (end
- start_first
), start_first
);
14084 /* bp_loc is a single value. */
14085 range
.first
= extract_bp_num (kind
, bp_loc
, '\0');
14086 range
.second
= range
.first
;
14091 /* Extract the breakpoint/location range specified by ARG. Returns
14092 the breakpoint range in BP_NUM_RANGE, and the location range in
14095 ARG may be in any of the following forms:
14097 x where 'x' is a breakpoint number.
14098 x-y where 'x' and 'y' specify a breakpoint numbers range.
14099 x.y where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' a location number.
14100 x.y-z where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' and 'z' specify a
14101 location number range.
14105 extract_bp_number_and_location (const std::string
&arg
,
14106 std::pair
<int, int> &bp_num_range
,
14107 std::pair
<int, int> &bp_loc_range
)
14109 std::string::size_type dot
= arg
.find ('.');
14111 if (dot
!= std::string::npos
)
14113 /* Handle 'x.y' and 'x.y-z' cases. */
14115 if (arg
.length () == dot
+ 1 || dot
== 0)
14116 error (_("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'"), arg
.c_str ());
14119 = extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind::bp
, arg
.c_str (), '.');
14120 bp_num_range
.second
= bp_num_range
.first
;
14122 bp_loc_range
= extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::loc
,
14127 /* Handle x and x-y cases. */
14129 bp_num_range
= extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::bp
, arg
, 0);
14130 bp_loc_range
.first
= 0;
14131 bp_loc_range
.second
= 0;
14135 /* Enable or disable a breakpoint location BP_NUM.LOC_NUM. ENABLE
14136 specifies whether to enable or disable. */
14139 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (int bp_num
, int loc_num
, bool enable
)
14141 struct bp_location
*loc
= find_location_by_number (bp_num
, loc_num
);
14144 if (loc
->enabled
!= enable
)
14146 loc
->enabled
= enable
;
14147 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc
);
14149 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14150 && current_trace_status ()->running
&& loc
->owner
14151 && is_tracepoint (loc
->owner
))
14152 target_disable_tracepoint (loc
);
14154 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT
);
14156 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified
.notify (loc
->owner
);
14159 /* Enable or disable a range of breakpoint locations. BP_NUM is the
14160 number of the breakpoint, and BP_LOC_RANGE specifies the
14161 (inclusive) range of location numbers of that breakpoint to
14162 enable/disable. ENABLE specifies whether to enable or disable the
14166 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range (int bp_num
,
14167 std::pair
<int, int> &bp_loc_range
,
14170 for (int i
= bp_loc_range
.first
; i
<= bp_loc_range
.second
; i
++)
14171 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (bp_num
, i
, enable
);
14174 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14175 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14176 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14179 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint
*bpt
)
14181 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
14182 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
14183 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
14184 if (bpt
->type
== bp_watchpoint_scope
)
14187 bpt
->enable_state
= bp_disabled
;
14189 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14190 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt
);
14192 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14193 && current_trace_status ()->running
&& is_tracepoint (bpt
))
14195 struct bp_location
*location
;
14197 for (location
= bpt
->loc
; location
; location
= location
->next
)
14198 target_disable_tracepoint (location
);
14201 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT
);
14203 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified
.notify (bpt
);
14206 /* Enable or disable the breakpoint(s) or breakpoint location(s)
14207 specified in ARGS. ARGS may be in any of the formats handled by
14208 extract_bp_number_and_location. ENABLE specifies whether to enable
14209 or disable the breakpoints/locations. */
14212 enable_disable_command (const char *args
, int from_tty
, bool enable
)
14216 struct breakpoint
*bpt
;
14218 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt
)
14219 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt
))
14222 enable_breakpoint (bpt
);
14224 disable_breakpoint (bpt
);
14229 std::string num
= extract_arg (&args
);
14231 while (!num
.empty ())
14233 std::pair
<int, int> bp_num_range
, bp_loc_range
;
14235 extract_bp_number_and_location (num
, bp_num_range
, bp_loc_range
);
14237 if (bp_loc_range
.first
== bp_loc_range
.second
14238 && bp_loc_range
.first
== 0)
14240 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x' or 'x-z'. */
14241 map_breakpoint_number_range (bp_num_range
,
14243 ? enable_breakpoint
14244 : disable_breakpoint
);
14248 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x.y' or
14250 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range
14251 (bp_num_range
.first
, bp_loc_range
, enable
);
14253 num
= extract_arg (&args
);
14258 /* The disable command disables the specified breakpoints/locations
14259 (or all defined breakpoints) so they're no longer effective in
14260 stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the forms defined in
14261 extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14264 disable_command (const char *args
, int from_tty
)
14266 enable_disable_command (args
, from_tty
, false);
14270 enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint
*bpt
, enum bpdisp disposition
,
14273 int target_resources_ok
;
14275 if (bpt
->type
== bp_hardware_breakpoint
)
14278 i
= hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
14279 target_resources_ok
=
14280 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint
,
14282 if (target_resources_ok
== 0)
14283 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
14284 else if (target_resources_ok
< 0)
14285 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
14288 if (is_watchpoint (bpt
))
14290 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
14291 enum enable_state orig_enable_state
= bp_disabled
;
14295 struct watchpoint
*w
= (struct watchpoint
*) bpt
;
14297 orig_enable_state
= bpt
->enable_state
;
14298 bpt
->enable_state
= bp_enabled
;
14299 update_watchpoint (w
, 1 /* reparse */);
14301 catch (const gdb_exception
&e
)
14303 bpt
->enable_state
= orig_enable_state
;
14304 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr
, e
, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
14310 bpt
->enable_state
= bp_enabled
;
14312 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14313 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt
);
14315 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14316 && current_trace_status ()->running
&& is_tracepoint (bpt
))
14318 struct bp_location
*location
;
14320 for (location
= bpt
->loc
; location
; location
= location
->next
)
14321 target_enable_tracepoint (location
);
14324 bpt
->disposition
= disposition
;
14325 bpt
->enable_count
= count
;
14326 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT
);
14328 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified
.notify (bpt
);
14333 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint
*bpt
)
14335 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt
, bpt
->disposition
, 0);
14338 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints/locations (or
14339 all defined breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to
14340 be) effective in stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the
14341 forms defined in extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14344 enable_command (const char *args
, int from_tty
)
14346 enable_disable_command (args
, from_tty
, true);
14350 enable_once_command (const char *args
, int from_tty
)
14352 map_breakpoint_numbers
14353 (args
, [&] (breakpoint
*b
)
14355 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14356 (b
, [&] (breakpoint
*bpt
)
14358 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt
, disp_disable
, 1);
14364 enable_count_command (const char *args
, int from_tty
)
14369 error_no_arg (_("hit count"));
14371 count
= get_number (&args
);
14373 map_breakpoint_numbers
14374 (args
, [&] (breakpoint
*b
)
14376 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14377 (b
, [&] (breakpoint
*bpt
)
14379 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt
, disp_disable
, count
);
14385 enable_delete_command (const char *args
, int from_tty
)
14387 map_breakpoint_numbers
14388 (args
, [&] (breakpoint
*b
)
14390 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14391 (b
, [&] (breakpoint
*bpt
)
14393 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt
, disp_del
, 1);
14398 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
14399 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
14403 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior
*inferior
,
14404 CORE_ADDR addr
, ssize_t len
,
14405 const bfd_byte
*data
)
14407 struct breakpoint
*bp
;
14409 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp
)
14410 if (bp
->enable_state
== bp_enabled
14411 && bp
->type
== bp_hardware_watchpoint
)
14413 struct watchpoint
*wp
= (struct watchpoint
*) bp
;
14415 if (wp
->val_valid
&& wp
->val
!= nullptr)
14417 struct bp_location
*loc
;
14419 for (loc
= bp
->loc
; loc
!= NULL
; loc
= loc
->next
)
14420 if (loc
->loc_type
== bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
14421 && loc
->address
+ loc
->length
> addr
14422 && addr
+ len
> loc
->address
)
14425 wp
->val_valid
= false;
14431 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
14434 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
,
14435 const address_space
*aspace
,
14438 struct thread_info
*tp
= inferior_thread ();
14439 struct symtab_and_line sal
;
14440 CORE_ADDR pc
= next_pc
;
14442 if (tp
->control
.single_step_breakpoints
== NULL
)
14444 tp
->control
.single_step_breakpoints
14445 = new_single_step_breakpoint (tp
->global_num
, gdbarch
);
14448 sal
= find_pc_line (pc
, 0);
14450 sal
.section
= find_pc_overlay (pc
);
14451 sal
.explicit_pc
= 1;
14452 add_location_to_breakpoint (tp
->control
.single_step_breakpoints
, &sal
);
14454 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT
);
14457 /* Insert single step breakpoints according to the current state. */
14460 insert_single_step_breakpoints (struct gdbarch
*gdbarch
)
14462 struct regcache
*regcache
= get_current_regcache ();
14463 std::vector
<CORE_ADDR
> next_pcs
;
14465 next_pcs
= gdbarch_software_single_step (gdbarch
, regcache
);
14467 if (!next_pcs
.empty ())
14469 struct frame_info
*frame
= get_current_frame ();
14470 const address_space
*aspace
= get_frame_address_space (frame
);
14472 for (CORE_ADDR pc
: next_pcs
)
14473 insert_single_step_breakpoint (gdbarch
, aspace
, pc
);
14481 /* See breakpoint.h. */
14484 breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint
*bp
,
14485 const address_space
*aspace
,
14488 struct bp_location
*loc
;
14490 for (loc
= bp
->loc
; loc
!= NULL
; loc
= loc
->next
)
14492 && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc
, aspace
, pc
))
14498 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
14502 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space
*aspace
,
14505 struct breakpoint
*bpt
;
14507 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt
)
14509 if (bpt
->type
== bp_single_step
14510 && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt
, aspace
, pc
))
14516 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
14518 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
14520 set_tracepoint_count (int num
)
14522 tracepoint_count
= num
;
14523 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num
);
14527 trace_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
14529 event_location_up location
= string_to_event_location (&arg
,
14531 const struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
= breakpoint_ops_for_event_location
14532 (location
.get (), true /* is_tracepoint */);
14534 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14536 NULL
, 0, arg
, 1 /* parse arg */,
14538 bp_tracepoint
/* type_wanted */,
14539 0 /* Ignore count */,
14540 pending_break_support
,
14544 0 /* internal */, 0);
14548 ftrace_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
14550 event_location_up location
= string_to_event_location (&arg
,
14552 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14554 NULL
, 0, arg
, 1 /* parse arg */,
14556 bp_fast_tracepoint
/* type_wanted */,
14557 0 /* Ignore count */,
14558 pending_break_support
,
14559 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops
,
14562 0 /* internal */, 0);
14565 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
14568 strace_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
14570 struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
;
14571 event_location_up location
;
14573 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
14574 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
14575 if (arg
&& startswith (arg
, "-m") && isspace (arg
[2]))
14577 ops
= &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops
;
14578 location
= new_linespec_location (&arg
, symbol_name_match_type::FULL
);
14582 ops
= &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops
;
14583 location
= string_to_event_location (&arg
, current_language
);
14586 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14588 NULL
, 0, arg
, 1 /* parse arg */,
14590 bp_static_tracepoint
/* type_wanted */,
14591 0 /* Ignore count */,
14592 pending_break_support
,
14596 0 /* internal */, 0);
14599 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
14600 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
14602 static struct uploaded_tp
*this_utp
;
14603 static int next_cmd
;
14606 read_uploaded_action (void)
14608 char *rslt
= nullptr;
14610 if (next_cmd
< this_utp
->cmd_strings
.size ())
14612 rslt
= this_utp
->cmd_strings
[next_cmd
].get ();
14619 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
14620 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
14621 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
14622 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
14623 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
14625 struct tracepoint
*
14626 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp
*utp
)
14628 const char *addr_str
;
14629 char small_buf
[100];
14630 struct tracepoint
*tp
;
14632 if (utp
->at_string
)
14633 addr_str
= utp
->at_string
.get ();
14636 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
14637 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
14638 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
14640 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
14641 "source location, using raw address"),
14643 xsnprintf (small_buf
, sizeof (small_buf
), "*%s", hex_string (utp
->addr
));
14644 addr_str
= small_buf
;
14647 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
14648 if (utp
->cond
&& !utp
->cond_string
)
14649 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
14650 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
14653 event_location_up location
= string_to_event_location (&addr_str
,
14655 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14657 utp
->cond_string
.get (), -1, addr_str
,
14658 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
14660 utp
->type
/* type_wanted */,
14661 0 /* Ignore count */,
14662 pending_break_support
,
14663 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops
,
14665 utp
->enabled
/* enabled */,
14667 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED
))
14670 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
14671 tp
= get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count
);
14672 gdb_assert (tp
!= NULL
);
14676 xsnprintf (small_buf
, sizeof (small_buf
), "%d %d", utp
->pass
,
14679 trace_pass_command (small_buf
, 0);
14682 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
14683 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
14684 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
14686 if (!utp
->cmd_strings
.empty ())
14688 counted_command_line cmd_list
;
14693 cmd_list
= read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action
, 1, NULL
);
14695 breakpoint_set_commands (tp
, std::move (cmd_list
));
14697 else if (!utp
->actions
.empty ()
14698 || !utp
->step_actions
.empty ())
14699 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
14700 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
14703 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
14704 tp
->hit_count
= utp
->hit_count
;
14705 tp
->traceframe_usage
= utp
->traceframe_usage
;
14710 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
14714 info_tracepoints_command (const char *args
, int from_tty
)
14716 struct ui_out
*uiout
= current_uiout
;
14719 num_printed
= breakpoint_1 (args
, false, is_tracepoint
);
14721 if (num_printed
== 0)
14723 if (args
== NULL
|| *args
== '\0')
14724 uiout
->message ("No tracepoints.\n");
14726 uiout
->message ("No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args
);
14729 default_collect_info ();
14732 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
14733 Not supported by all targets. */
14735 enable_trace_command (const char *args
, int from_tty
)
14737 enable_command (args
, from_tty
);
14740 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
14741 Not supported by all targets. */
14743 disable_trace_command (const char *args
, int from_tty
)
14745 disable_command (args
, from_tty
);
14748 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
14750 delete_trace_command (const char *arg
, int from_tty
)
14752 struct breakpoint
*b
, *b_tmp
;
14758 int breaks_to_delete
= 0;
14760 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
14761 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
14762 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
14764 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b
)
14765 if (is_tracepoint (b
) && user_breakpoint_p (b
))
14767 breaks_to_delete
= 1;
14771 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
14773 || (breaks_to_delete
&& query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
14775 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, b_tmp
)
14776 if (is_tracepoint (b
) && user_breakpoint_p (b
))
14777 delete_breakpoint (b
);
14781 map_breakpoint_numbers
14782 (arg
, [&] (breakpoint
*br
)
14784 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br
, delete_breakpoint
);
14788 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
14791 trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint
*tp
, int count
, int from_tty
)
14793 tp
->pass_count
= count
;
14794 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified
.notify (tp
);
14796 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
14797 tp
->number
, count
);
14800 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
14802 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
14803 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
14804 Also accepts special argument "all". */
14807 trace_pass_command (const char *args
, int from_tty
)
14809 struct tracepoint
*t1
;
14812 if (args
== 0 || *args
== 0)
14813 error (_("passcount command requires an "
14814 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
14816 count
= strtoulst (args
, &args
, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
14818 args
= skip_spaces (args
);
14819 if (*args
&& strncasecmp (args
, "all", 3) == 0)
14821 struct breakpoint
*b
;
14823 args
+= 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
14825 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
14827 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b
)
14829 t1
= (struct tracepoint
*) b
;
14830 trace_pass_set_count (t1
, count
, from_tty
);
14833 else if (*args
== '\0')
14835 t1
= get_tracepoint_by_number (&args
, NULL
);
14837 trace_pass_set_count (t1
, count
, from_tty
);
14841 number_or_range_parser
parser (args
);
14842 while (!parser
.finished ())
14844 t1
= get_tracepoint_by_number (&args
, &parser
);
14846 trace_pass_set_count (t1
, count
, from_tty
);
14851 struct tracepoint
*
14852 get_tracepoint (int num
)
14854 struct breakpoint
*t
;
14856 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t
)
14857 if (t
->number
== num
)
14858 return (struct tracepoint
*) t
;
14863 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
14864 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
14867 struct tracepoint
*
14868 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num
)
14870 struct breakpoint
*b
;
14872 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b
)
14874 struct tracepoint
*t
= (struct tracepoint
*) b
;
14876 if (t
->number_on_target
== num
)
14883 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
14884 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
14885 If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
14886 (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
14888 struct tracepoint
*
14889 get_tracepoint_by_number (const char **arg
,
14890 number_or_range_parser
*parser
)
14892 struct breakpoint
*t
;
14894 const char *instring
= arg
== NULL
? NULL
: *arg
;
14896 if (parser
!= NULL
)
14898 gdb_assert (!parser
->finished ());
14899 tpnum
= parser
->get_number ();
14901 else if (arg
== NULL
|| *arg
== NULL
|| ! **arg
)
14902 tpnum
= tracepoint_count
;
14904 tpnum
= get_number (arg
);
14908 if (instring
&& *instring
)
14909 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
14912 printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
14916 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t
)
14917 if (t
->number
== tpnum
)
14919 return (struct tracepoint
*) t
;
14922 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum
);
14927 print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint
*b
, struct ui_file
*fp
)
14929 if (b
->thread
!= -1)
14930 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, " thread %d", b
->thread
);
14933 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, " task %d", b
->task
);
14935 fprintf_unfiltered (fp
, "\n");
14938 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
14939 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
14940 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
14944 save_breakpoints (const char *filename
, int from_tty
,
14945 bool (*filter
) (const struct breakpoint
*))
14947 struct breakpoint
*tp
;
14949 int extra_trace_bits
= 0;
14951 if (filename
== 0 || *filename
== 0)
14952 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
14954 /* See if we have anything to save. */
14955 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp
)
14957 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
14958 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp
))
14961 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
14962 if (filter
&& !filter (tp
))
14967 if (is_tracepoint (tp
))
14969 extra_trace_bits
= 1;
14971 /* We can stop searching. */
14978 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
14982 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr
<char> expanded_filename (tilde_expand (filename
));
14986 if (!fp
.open (expanded_filename
.get (), "w"))
14987 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
14988 expanded_filename
.get (), safe_strerror (errno
));
14990 if (extra_trace_bits
)
14991 save_trace_state_variables (&fp
);
14993 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp
)
14995 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
14996 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp
))
14999 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15000 if (filter
&& !filter (tp
))
15003 tp
->ops
->print_recreate (tp
, &fp
);
15005 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
15006 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
15009 if (tp
->cond_string
)
15010 fp
.printf (" condition $bpnum %s\n", tp
->cond_string
);
15012 if (tp
->ignore_count
)
15013 fp
.printf (" ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp
->ignore_count
);
15015 if (tp
->type
!= bp_dprintf
&& tp
->commands
)
15017 fp
.puts (" commands\n");
15019 current_uiout
->redirect (&fp
);
15022 print_command_lines (current_uiout
, tp
->commands
.get (), 2);
15024 catch (const gdb_exception
&ex
)
15026 current_uiout
->redirect (NULL
);
15030 current_uiout
->redirect (NULL
);
15031 fp
.puts (" end\n");
15034 if (tp
->enable_state
== bp_disabled
)
15035 fp
.puts ("disable $bpnum\n");
15037 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
15038 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
15039 special, and not user visible. */
15040 if (!is_watchpoint (tp
) && tp
->loc
&& tp
->loc
->next
)
15042 struct bp_location
*loc
;
15045 for (loc
= tp
->loc
; loc
!= NULL
; loc
= loc
->next
, n
++)
15047 fp
.printf ("disable $bpnum.%d\n", n
);
15051 if (extra_trace_bits
&& *default_collect
)
15052 fp
.printf ("set default-collect %s\n", default_collect
);
15055 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), expanded_filename
.get ());
15058 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
15061 save_breakpoints_command (const char *args
, int from_tty
)
15063 save_breakpoints (args
, from_tty
, NULL
);
15066 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
15069 save_tracepoints_command (const char *args
, int from_tty
)
15071 save_breakpoints (args
, from_tty
, is_tracepoint
);
15074 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
15076 std::vector
<breakpoint
*>
15077 all_tracepoints (void)
15079 std::vector
<breakpoint
*> tp_vec
;
15080 struct breakpoint
*tp
;
15082 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp
)
15084 tp_vec
.push_back (tp
);
15091 /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying
15092 locations used by several commands. */
15094 #define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \
15095 "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\
15096 source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\
15097 Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15098 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\
15099 \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\
15101 Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\
15102 program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\
15103 \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\
15105 Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\
15106 syntax to specify location parameters.\n\
15107 Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15108 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\
15109 -function fact -label the_top\".\n\
15111 By default, a specified function is matched against the program's\n\
15112 functions in all scopes. For C++, this means in all namespaces and\n\
15113 classes. For Ada, this means in all packages. E.g., in C++,\n\
15114 \"func()\" matches \"A::func()\", \"A::B::func()\", etc. The\n\
15115 \"-qualified\" flag overrides this behavior, making GDB interpret the\n\
15116 specified name as a complete fully-qualified name instead."
15118 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
15119 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
15120 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
15123 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
15124 command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
15125 PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
15126 probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
15127 guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\
15128 `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\
15129 LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\
15132 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
15133 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
15135 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
15136 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15137 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\
15138 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15139 conditions are different.\n\
15141 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
15143 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
15144 static struct cmd_list_element
*catch_cmdlist
;
15146 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
15147 static struct cmd_list_element
*tcatch_cmdlist
;
15150 add_catch_command (const char *name
, const char *docstring
,
15151 cmd_const_sfunc_ftype
*sfunc
,
15152 completer_ftype
*completer
,
15153 void *user_data_catch
,
15154 void *user_data_tcatch
)
15156 struct cmd_list_element
*command
;
15158 command
= add_cmd (name
, class_breakpoint
, docstring
,
15160 set_cmd_sfunc (command
, sfunc
);
15161 set_cmd_context (command
, user_data_catch
);
15162 set_cmd_completer (command
, completer
);
15164 command
= add_cmd (name
, class_breakpoint
, docstring
,
15166 set_cmd_sfunc (command
, sfunc
);
15167 set_cmd_context (command
, user_data_tcatch
);
15168 set_cmd_completer (command
, completer
);
15171 struct breakpoint
*
15172 iterate_over_breakpoints (gdb::function_view
<bool (breakpoint
*)> callback
)
15174 struct breakpoint
*b
, *b_tmp
;
15176 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b
, b_tmp
)
15185 /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
15186 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
15189 is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint
*b
)
15191 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
15192 non-inline function. */
15193 if (b
->type
== bp_shlib_event
)
15199 /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
15200 have been inlined. */
15203 pc_at_non_inline_function (const address_space
*aspace
, CORE_ADDR pc
,
15204 const struct target_waitstatus
*ws
)
15206 struct breakpoint
*b
;
15207 struct bp_location
*bl
;
15209 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b
)
15211 if (!is_non_inline_function (b
))
15214 for (bl
= b
->loc
; bl
!= NULL
; bl
= bl
->next
)
15216 if (!bl
->shlib_disabled
15217 && bpstat_check_location (bl
, aspace
, pc
, ws
))
15225 /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
15228 breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile
*objfile
)
15230 struct bp_location
**locp
, *loc
;
15232 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc
, locp
)
15233 if (loc
->symtab
!= NULL
&& SYMTAB_OBJFILE (loc
->symtab
) == objfile
)
15234 loc
->symtab
= NULL
;
15238 initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
15240 static int initialized
= 0;
15242 struct breakpoint_ops
*ops
;
15248 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
15249 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
15250 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
15251 ops
= &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops
;
15252 *ops
= base_breakpoint_ops
;
15253 ops
->re_set
= bkpt_re_set
;
15254 ops
->insert_location
= bkpt_insert_location
;
15255 ops
->remove_location
= bkpt_remove_location
;
15256 ops
->breakpoint_hit
= bkpt_breakpoint_hit
;
15257 ops
->create_sals_from_location
= bkpt_create_sals_from_location
;
15258 ops
->create_breakpoints_sal
= bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal
;
15259 ops
->decode_location
= bkpt_decode_location
;
15261 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
15262 ops
= &bkpt_breakpoint_ops
;
15263 *ops
= bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops
;
15264 ops
->re_set
= bkpt_re_set
;
15265 ops
->resources_needed
= bkpt_resources_needed
;
15266 ops
->print_it
= bkpt_print_it
;
15267 ops
->print_mention
= bkpt_print_mention
;
15268 ops
->print_recreate
= bkpt_print_recreate
;
15270 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
15271 ops
= &ranged_breakpoint_ops
;
15272 *ops
= bkpt_breakpoint_ops
;
15273 ops
->breakpoint_hit
= breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint
;
15274 ops
->resources_needed
= resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint
;
15275 ops
->print_it
= print_it_ranged_breakpoint
;
15276 ops
->print_one
= print_one_ranged_breakpoint
;
15277 ops
->print_one_detail
= print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint
;
15278 ops
->print_mention
= print_mention_ranged_breakpoint
;
15279 ops
->print_recreate
= print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint
;
15281 /* Internal breakpoints. */
15282 ops
= &internal_breakpoint_ops
;
15283 *ops
= bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops
;
15284 ops
->re_set
= internal_bkpt_re_set
;
15285 ops
->check_status
= internal_bkpt_check_status
;
15286 ops
->print_it
= internal_bkpt_print_it
;
15287 ops
->print_mention
= internal_bkpt_print_mention
;
15289 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
15290 ops
= &momentary_breakpoint_ops
;
15291 *ops
= bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops
;
15292 ops
->re_set
= momentary_bkpt_re_set
;
15293 ops
->check_status
= momentary_bkpt_check_status
;
15294 ops
->print_it
= momentary_bkpt_print_it
;
15295 ops
->print_mention
= momentary_bkpt_print_mention
;
15297 /* Probe breakpoints. */
15298 ops
= &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops
;
15299 *ops
= bkpt_breakpoint_ops
;
15300 ops
->insert_location
= bkpt_probe_insert_location
;
15301 ops
->remove_location
= bkpt_probe_remove_location
;
15302 ops
->create_sals_from_location
= bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location
;
15303 ops
->decode_location
= bkpt_probe_decode_location
;
15306 ops
= &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops
;
15307 *ops
= base_breakpoint_ops
;
15308 ops
->re_set
= re_set_watchpoint
;
15309 ops
->insert_location
= insert_watchpoint
;
15310 ops
->remove_location
= remove_watchpoint
;
15311 ops
->breakpoint_hit
= breakpoint_hit_watchpoint
;
15312 ops
->check_status
= check_status_watchpoint
;
15313 ops
->resources_needed
= resources_needed_watchpoint
;
15314 ops
->works_in_software_mode
= works_in_software_mode_watchpoint
;
15315 ops
->print_it
= print_it_watchpoint
;
15316 ops
->print_mention
= print_mention_watchpoint
;
15317 ops
->print_recreate
= print_recreate_watchpoint
;
15318 ops
->explains_signal
= explains_signal_watchpoint
;
15320 /* Masked watchpoints. */
15321 ops
= &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops
;
15322 *ops
= watchpoint_breakpoint_ops
;
15323 ops
->insert_location
= insert_masked_watchpoint
;
15324 ops
->remove_location
= remove_masked_watchpoint
;
15325 ops
->resources_needed
= resources_needed_masked_watchpoint
;
15326 ops
->works_in_software_mode
= works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint
;
15327 ops
->print_it
= print_it_masked_watchpoint
;
15328 ops
->print_one_detail
= print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint
;
15329 ops
->print_mention
= print_mention_masked_watchpoint
;
15330 ops
->print_recreate
= print_recreate_masked_watchpoint
;
15333 ops
= &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops
;
15334 *ops
= base_breakpoint_ops
;
15335 ops
->re_set
= tracepoint_re_set
;
15336 ops
->breakpoint_hit
= tracepoint_breakpoint_hit
;
15337 ops
->print_one_detail
= tracepoint_print_one_detail
;
15338 ops
->print_mention
= tracepoint_print_mention
;
15339 ops
->print_recreate
= tracepoint_print_recreate
;
15340 ops
->create_sals_from_location
= tracepoint_create_sals_from_location
;
15341 ops
->create_breakpoints_sal
= tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal
;
15342 ops
->decode_location
= tracepoint_decode_location
;
15344 /* Probe tracepoints. */
15345 ops
= &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops
;
15346 *ops
= tracepoint_breakpoint_ops
;
15347 ops
->create_sals_from_location
= tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location
;
15348 ops
->decode_location
= tracepoint_probe_decode_location
;
15350 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
15351 ops
= &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops
;
15352 *ops
= tracepoint_breakpoint_ops
;
15353 ops
->create_sals_from_location
= strace_marker_create_sals_from_location
;
15354 ops
->create_breakpoints_sal
= strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal
;
15355 ops
->decode_location
= strace_marker_decode_location
;
15357 /* Fork catchpoints. */
15358 ops
= &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops
;
15359 *ops
= base_breakpoint_ops
;
15360 ops
->insert_location
= insert_catch_fork
;
15361 ops
->remove_location
= remove_catch_fork
;
15362 ops
->breakpoint_hit
= breakpoint_hit_catch_fork
;
15363 ops
->print_it
= print_it_catch_fork
;
15364 ops
->print_one
= print_one_catch_fork
;
15365 ops
->print_mention
= print_mention_catch_fork
;
15366 ops
->print_recreate
= print_recreate_catch_fork
;
15368 /* Vfork catchpoints. */
15369 ops
= &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops
;
15370 *ops
= base_breakpoint_ops
;
15371 ops
->insert_location
= insert_catch_vfork
;
15372 ops
->remove_location
= remove_catch_vfork
;
15373 ops
->breakpoint_hit
= breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork
;
15374 ops
->print_it
= print_it_catch_vfork
;
15375 ops
->print_one
= print_one_catch_vfork
;
15376 ops
->print_mention
= print_mention_catch_vfork
;
15377 ops
->print_recreate
= print_recreate_catch_vfork
;
15379 /* Exec catchpoints. */
15380 ops
= &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops
;
15381 *ops
= base_breakpoint_ops
;
15382 ops
->insert_location
= insert_catch_exec
;
15383 ops
->remove_location
= remove_catch_exec
;
15384 ops
->breakpoint_hit
= breakpoint_hit_catch_exec
;
15385 ops
->print_it
= print_it_catch_exec
;
15386 ops
->print_one
= print_one_catch_exec
;
15387 ops
->print_mention
= print_mention_catch_exec
;
15388 ops
->print_recreate
= print_recreate_catch_exec
;
15390 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
15391 ops
= &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops
;
15392 *ops
= base_breakpoint_ops
;
15393 ops
->insert_location
= insert_catch_solib
;
15394 ops
->remove_location
= remove_catch_solib
;
15395 ops
->breakpoint_hit
= breakpoint_hit_catch_solib
;
15396 ops
->check_status
= check_status_catch_solib
;
15397 ops
->print_it
= print_it_catch_solib
;
15398 ops
->print_one
= print_one_catch_solib
;
15399 ops
->print_mention
= print_mention_catch_solib
;
15400 ops
->print_recreate
= print_recreate_catch_solib
;
15402 ops
= &dprintf_breakpoint_ops
;
15403 *ops
= bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops
;
15404 ops
->re_set
= dprintf_re_set
;
15405 ops
->resources_needed
= bkpt_resources_needed
;
15406 ops
->print_it
= bkpt_print_it
;
15407 ops
->print_mention
= bkpt_print_mention
;
15408 ops
->print_recreate
= dprintf_print_recreate
;
15409 ops
->after_condition_true
= dprintf_after_condition_true
;
15410 ops
->breakpoint_hit
= dprintf_breakpoint_hit
;
15413 /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
15415 static struct cmd_list_element
*enablebreaklist
= NULL
;
15417 /* See breakpoint.h. */
15419 cmd_list_element
*commands_cmd_element
= nullptr;
15421 void _initialize_breakpoint ();
15423 _initialize_breakpoint ()
15425 struct cmd_list_element
*c
;
15427 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
15429 gdb::observers::solib_unloaded
.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib
);
15430 gdb::observers::free_objfile
.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile
);
15431 gdb::observers::memory_changed
.attach (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change
);
15433 breakpoint_chain
= 0;
15434 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
15435 before a breakpoint is set. */
15436 breakpoint_count
= 0;
15438 tracepoint_count
= 0;
15440 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint
, ignore_command
, _("\
15441 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
15442 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
15444 commands_cmd_element
= add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint
,
15445 commands_command
, _("\
15446 Set commands to be executed when the given breakpoints are hit.\n\
15447 Give a space-separated breakpoint list as argument after \"commands\".\n\
15448 A list element can be a breakpoint number (e.g. `5') or a range of numbers\n\
15450 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
15451 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
15452 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
15453 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
15454 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
15456 c
= add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint
, condition_command
, _("\
15457 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
15458 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
15459 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
15460 set_cmd_completer (c
, condition_completer
);
15462 c
= add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint
, tbreak_command
, _("\
15463 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
15464 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15465 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
15466 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
15468 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
15469 set_cmd_completer (c
, location_completer
);
15471 c
= add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint
, hbreak_command
, _("\
15472 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15473 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
15474 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
15476 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
15477 set_cmd_completer (c
, location_completer
);
15479 c
= add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint
, thbreak_command
, _("\
15480 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15481 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15482 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
15484 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
15485 set_cmd_completer (c
, location_completer
);
15487 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint
, enable_command
, _("\
15488 Enable all or some breakpoints.\n\
15489 Usage: enable [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15490 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15491 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
15492 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15493 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
15494 &enablelist
, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist
);
15496 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint
, 1);
15498 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint
, enable_command
, _("\
15499 Enable all or some breakpoints.\n\
15500 Usage: enable breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15501 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15502 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15503 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\"."),
15504 &enablebreaklist
, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist
);
15506 add_cmd ("once", no_class
, enable_once_command
, _("\
15507 Enable some breakpoints for one hit.\n\
15508 Usage: enable breakpoints once BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15509 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15512 add_cmd ("delete", no_class
, enable_delete_command
, _("\
15513 Enable some breakpoints and delete when hit.\n\
15514 Usage: enable breakpoints delete BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15515 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15518 add_cmd ("count", no_class
, enable_count_command
, _("\
15519 Enable some breakpoints for COUNT hits.\n\
15520 Usage: enable breakpoints count COUNT BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15521 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15522 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15525 add_cmd ("delete", no_class
, enable_delete_command
, _("\
15526 Enable some breakpoints and delete when hit.\n\
15527 Usage: enable delete BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15528 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15531 add_cmd ("once", no_class
, enable_once_command
, _("\
15532 Enable some breakpoints for one hit.\n\
15533 Usage: enable once BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15534 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15537 add_cmd ("count", no_class
, enable_count_command
, _("\
15538 Enable some breakpoints for COUNT hits.\n\
15539 Usage: enable count COUNT BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15540 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15541 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15544 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint
, disable_command
, _("\
15545 Disable all or some breakpoints.\n\
15546 Usage: disable [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15547 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15548 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15549 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
15550 &disablelist
, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist
);
15551 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint
, 1);
15552 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint
, 1);
15554 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint
, disable_command
, _("\
15555 Disable all or some breakpoints.\n\
15556 Usage: disable breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15557 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15558 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15559 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
15560 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
15563 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint
, delete_command
, _("\
15564 Delete all or some breakpoints.\n\
15565 Usage: delete [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15566 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15567 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15569 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects."),
15570 &deletelist
, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist
);
15571 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint
, 1);
15572 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint
, 1);
15574 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint
, delete_command
, _("\
15575 Delete all or some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15576 Usage: delete breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15577 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15578 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15579 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
15582 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint
, clear_command
, _("\
15583 Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\
15584 Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\
15586 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
15587 is executing in.\n"
15588 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING
"\n\n\
15589 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
15590 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint
, 1);
15592 c
= add_com ("break", class_breakpoint
, break_command
, _("\
15593 Set breakpoint at specified location.\n"
15594 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
15595 set_cmd_completer (c
, location_completer
);
15597 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run
, 1);
15598 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run
, 1);
15599 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run
, 1);
15600 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run
, 1);
15604 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint
, stop_command
, _("\
15605 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
15606 &stoplist
, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist
);
15607 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint
, stopin_command
,
15608 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist
);
15609 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint
, stopat_command
,
15610 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist
);
15611 add_com ("status", class_info
, info_breakpoints_command
, _("\
15612 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15613 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15614 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15615 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15616 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15617 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15618 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15619 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15621 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15622 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15623 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15624 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15625 breakpoint set."));
15628 add_info ("breakpoints", info_breakpoints_command
, _("\
15629 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
15630 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15631 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15632 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15633 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15634 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15635 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15636 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15638 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15639 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15640 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15641 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15642 breakpoint set."));
15644 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
15646 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance
, maintenance_info_breakpoints
, _("\
15647 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15648 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15649 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15650 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15651 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
15652 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
15653 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
15654 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
15655 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15656 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15657 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15658 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15660 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15661 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15662 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15663 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15665 &maintenanceinfolist
);
15667 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint
, _("\
15668 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
15669 &catch_cmdlist
, "catch ",
15670 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist
);
15672 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint
, _("\
15673 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
15674 &tcatch_cmdlist
, "tcatch ",
15675 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist
);
15677 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
15678 catch_fork_command_1
,
15680 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent
,
15681 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary
);
15682 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
15683 catch_fork_command_1
,
15685 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent
,
15686 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary
);
15687 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
15688 catch_exec_command_1
,
15692 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
15693 Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
15694 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15695 catch_load_command_1
,
15699 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
15700 Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
15701 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15702 catch_unload_command_1
,
15707 c
= add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint
, watch_command
, _("\
15708 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15709 Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15710 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15711 an expression changes.\n\
15712 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15713 the memory to which it refers."));
15714 set_cmd_completer (c
, expression_completer
);
15716 c
= add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint
, rwatch_command
, _("\
15717 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15718 Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15719 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15720 an expression is read.\n\
15721 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15722 the memory to which it refers."));
15723 set_cmd_completer (c
, expression_completer
);
15725 c
= add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint
, awatch_command
, _("\
15726 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15727 Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15728 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15729 an expression is either read or written.\n\
15730 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15731 the memory to which it refers."));
15732 set_cmd_completer (c
, expression_completer
);
15734 add_info ("watchpoints", info_watchpoints_command
, _("\
15735 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
15737 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
15738 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
15739 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support
,
15740 &can_use_hw_watchpoints
, _("\
15741 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15742 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15743 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
15744 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
15745 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
15748 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints
,
15749 &setlist
, &showlist
);
15751 can_use_hw_watchpoints
= 1;
15753 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
15755 c
= add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint
, trace_command
, _("\
15756 Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15758 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
15759 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15760 set_cmd_completer (c
, location_completer
);
15762 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_breakpoint
, 0);
15763 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_breakpoint
, 1);
15764 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_breakpoint
, 1);
15765 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_breakpoint
, 1);
15767 c
= add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint
, ftrace_command
, _("\
15768 Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15770 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
15771 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15772 set_cmd_completer (c
, location_completer
);
15774 c
= add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint
, strace_command
, _("\
15775 Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\
15777 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
15778 LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\
15779 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\
15780 If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\
15781 no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\
15782 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
15783 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
15784 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
15785 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
15787 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15788 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING
"\n\n\
15789 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15790 conditions are different.\n\
15792 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
15793 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15794 set_cmd_completer (c
, location_completer
);
15796 add_info ("tracepoints", info_tracepoints_command
, _("\
15797 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
15798 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
15799 last tracepoint set."));
15801 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
15803 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace
, delete_trace_command
, _("\
15804 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
15805 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15806 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
15808 add_alias_cmd ("tr", "tracepoints", class_trace
, 1, &deletelist
);
15810 c
= add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace
, disable_trace_command
, _("\
15811 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
15812 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15813 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
15815 deprecate_cmd (c
, "disable");
15817 c
= add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace
, enable_trace_command
, _("\
15818 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
15819 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15820 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
15822 deprecate_cmd (c
, "enable");
15824 add_com ("passcount", class_trace
, trace_pass_command
, _("\
15825 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
15826 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
15827 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
15828 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
15830 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint
,
15831 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
15832 &save_cmdlist
, "save ",
15833 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist
);
15835 c
= add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint
, save_breakpoints_command
, _("\
15836 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
15837 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
15838 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
15839 session to restore them."),
15841 set_cmd_completer (c
, filename_completer
);
15843 c
= add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace
, save_tracepoints_command
, _("\
15844 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
15845 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
15847 set_cmd_completer (c
, filename_completer
);
15849 c
= add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace
, 0);
15850 deprecate_cmd (c
, "save tracepoints");
15852 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance
, _("\
15853 Breakpoint specific settings.\n\
15854 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15855 pending breakpoint behavior."),
15856 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist
, "set breakpoint ",
15857 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist
);
15858 add_show_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance
, _("\
15859 Breakpoint specific settings.\n\
15860 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15861 pending breakpoint behavior."),
15862 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist
, "show breakpoint ",
15863 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist
);
15865 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class
,
15866 &pending_break_support
, _("\
15867 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15868 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15869 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
15870 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
15871 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
15872 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
15874 show_pending_break_support
,
15875 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist
,
15876 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist
);
15878 pending_break_support
= AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
;
15880 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class
,
15881 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints
, _("\
15882 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15883 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15884 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
15885 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
15886 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
15888 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints
,
15889 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist
,
15890 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist
);
15892 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support
,
15893 &always_inserted_mode
, _("\
15894 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15895 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15896 When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\
15897 they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\
15898 only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\
15899 breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\
15900 when execution stops."),
15902 &show_always_inserted_mode
,
15903 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist
,
15904 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist
);
15906 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint
,
15907 condition_evaluation_enums
,
15908 &condition_evaluation_mode_1
, _("\
15909 Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15910 Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15911 When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
15912 evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
15913 breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
15914 supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
15915 If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
15916 \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
15917 be set to \"host\"."),
15918 &set_condition_evaluation_mode
,
15919 &show_condition_evaluation_mode
,
15920 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist
,
15921 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist
);
15923 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint
, break_range_command
, _("\
15924 Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
15925 break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
15926 where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
15927 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
15928 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
15929 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
15930 or the start of the range\n\
15931 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
15932 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
15933 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
15935 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
15936 an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
15937 range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
15939 c
= add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint
, dprintf_command
, _("\
15940 Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\
15941 dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
15942 location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n"
15943 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING
));
15944 set_cmd_completer (c
, location_completer
);
15946 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support
,
15947 dprintf_style_enums
, &dprintf_style
, _("\
15948 Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
15949 Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
15950 This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
15951 If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
15952 console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
15953 If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
15954 program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
15955 output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
15956 update_dprintf_commands
, NULL
,
15957 &setlist
, &showlist
);
15959 dprintf_function
= xstrdup ("printf");
15960 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support
,
15961 &dprintf_function
, _("\
15962 Set the function to use for dynamic printf."), _("\
15963 Show the function to use for dynamic printf."), NULL
,
15964 update_dprintf_commands
, NULL
,
15965 &setlist
, &showlist
);
15967 dprintf_channel
= xstrdup ("");
15968 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support
,
15969 &dprintf_channel
, _("\
15970 Set the channel to use for dynamic printf."), _("\
15971 Show the channel to use for dynamic printf."), NULL
,
15972 update_dprintf_commands
, NULL
,
15973 &setlist
, &showlist
);
15975 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class
,
15976 &disconnected_dprintf
, _("\
15977 Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
15978 Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
15979 Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
15980 even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
15983 &setlist
, &showlist
);
15985 add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars
, agent_printf_command
, _("\
15986 Target agent only formatted printing, like the C \"printf\" function.\n\
15987 Usage: agent-printf \"format string\", ARG1, ARG2, ARG3, ..., ARGN\n\
15988 This supports most C printf format specifications, like %s, %d, etc.\n\
15989 This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
15991 automatic_hardware_breakpoints
= true;
15993 gdb::observers::about_to_proceed
.attach (breakpoint_about_to_proceed
);
15994 gdb::observers::thread_exit
.attach (remove_threaded_breakpoints
);